479bf34ecbad1b72d7c9afe21fe1ac19647ac316
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
34 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
35 Free Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * TFTP:: TFTP
83 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
84 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
85 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
86 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
87 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
88
89 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
90 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
91 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
92 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
93 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
94 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
95 @end menu
96
97 @node About
98 @unnumbered About
99 @cindex about
100
101 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
102 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
103 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
104 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
105 around the world.
106
107 @section What is OpenOCD?
108 @cindex TAP
109 @cindex JTAG
110
111 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
112 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
113 devices.
114
115 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
116 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
117 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
118 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
119 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
120 needed to hook up to the target.
121
122 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
123 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
124 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
125 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
126 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
127
128 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
129 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
130 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
131 let the development board connect directly to the debug
132 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
133
134 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
135 signaling, and is used to communicate
136 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
137 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
138 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
139 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
140 scan operations.
141
142 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
143 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
144 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
145 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
146
147 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
148 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
149 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
150 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
151
152
153 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
154 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
155 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
156
157 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
158 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
159 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
160 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
161
162 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
163 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
164 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
165 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
166 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
167
168 @section OpenOCD Web Site
169
170 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
171
172 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
173
174 @section Latest User's Guide:
175
176 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
177 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
178 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
179
180 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
181
182 PDF form is likewise published at:
183
184 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
185
186 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
187
188 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
189 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
190 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
191 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
192 instead of this forum.
193
194 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
195
196 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
197
198 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
199 communication between users:
200
201 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
202
203 @section OpenOCD IRC
204
205 Support can also be found on irc:
206 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
207
208 @node Developers
209 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
210 @cindex developers
211
212 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
213 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
214 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
215 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
216
217 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
218 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
219
220 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
221
222 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
223 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
224
225 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
226
227 or via http
228
229 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
230
231 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
232
233 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
234
235 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
236 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
237 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
238 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
239 needing a Git client:
240
241 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
242
243 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
244 from the repository or a snapshot.
245
246 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
247 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
248 Patches created against older versions may require additional
249 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
250
251 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
252
253 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
254 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
255 technical information about the software internals, development
256 processes, and similar documentation:
257
258 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
259
260 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
261 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
262 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
263
264 @section Gerrit Review System
265
266 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
267 Code Review System:
268
269 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
270
271 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
272 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
273 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
274 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
275 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
276
277 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
278 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
279 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
280 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
281 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
282
283 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
284
285 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
286 communication between developers:
287
288 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
289
290 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
291
292 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
293
294 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
295
296
297 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
299 @cindex dongles
300 @cindex FTDI
301 @cindex wiggler
302 @cindex zy1000
303 @cindex printer port
304 @cindex USB Adapter
305 @cindex RTCK
306
307 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
308 an adapter .... [snip]
309
310 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
311 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
312 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
313 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
314 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
315 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
316 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
317
318
319 @section Choosing a Dongle
320
321 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
322
323 @enumerate
324 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
325 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
326 other ways to communicate with target devices.
327 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
328 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
329 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
330 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
331 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
332 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
333 Ethernet port needed?
334 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
335 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
336 @end enumerate
337
338 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
339
340 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
341 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
342 running on the developer's host computer.
343 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
344 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
345 IP address assigned to the probe.
346 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
347 OpenOCD debugger.
348 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
349 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
350 the target.
351 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
352 to power cycle the target remotely.
353
354 For more information, visit:
355
356 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
357
358 @section USB FT2232 Based
359
360 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
361 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
362 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
363 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
364 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
365 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
366 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
367 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
368 clocking.)
369
370 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
371 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
372 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
373 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
374 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
375
376 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
377 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
378
379 @itemize @bullet
380 @item @b{usbjtag}
381 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
382 @item @b{jtagkey}
383 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
384 @item @b{jtagkey2}
385 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
386 @item @b{oocdlink}
387 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
388 @item @b{signalyzer}
389 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
390 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
391 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
392 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
393 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
394 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
395 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
396 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
397 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
398 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
399 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
400 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
401 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
402 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
403 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
404 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
405 @item @b{turtelizer2}
406 @* See:
407 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
408 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
409 @item @b{comstick}
410 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
411 @item @b{stm32stick}
412 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
413 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
414 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
415 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
416 @item @b{cortino}
417 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
418 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
419 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
420 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
421 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
422 @item @b{opendous}
423 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
424 (OpenHardware).
425 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
426 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
427
428 @item @b{GW16042}
429 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
430 FT2232H-based
431
432 @end itemize
433 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
434
435 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
436 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
437 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
438 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
439 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
440
441 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
442 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
443 (see the section on driver commands).
444
445 @itemize
446 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
447 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
448 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB J-Link based
453 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
454 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
455 AT91SAM764 internally.
456
457 @itemize @bullet
458 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
460 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
461 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
462 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
463 @end itemize
464
465 @section USB RLINK based
466 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
467 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
468 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
469
470 @itemize @bullet
471 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
472 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
473 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
474 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
475 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
476 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
477 @end itemize
478
479 @section USB ST-LINK based
480 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
481 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
482
483 @itemize @bullet
484 @item @b{ST-LINK}
485 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
486 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
487 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
488 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
489 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
490 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
491 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
492 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
493 @end itemize
494
495 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
496 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
497 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
498 @itemize @bullet
499 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
500 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
501 @end itemize
502
503 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
504 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
505 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
506 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
507
508 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
509 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
510 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
511
512 @section USB Other
513 @itemize @bullet
514 @item @b{USBprog}
515 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
516
517 @item @b{USB - Presto}
518 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
519
520 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
521 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
522
523 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
524 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
525
526 @item @b{Buspirate}
527 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
528
529 @item @b{opendous}
530 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
531
532 @item @b{estick}
533 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
534
535 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
536 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
537
538 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
539 @* The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
540 LaunchPad evaluation boards.
541 @* The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB debug probe. The XDS110
542 stand-alone probe has the additional ability to supply voltage to the target
543 board via its AUX FUNCTIONS port. Use the
544 @command{xds110_supply_voltage <millivolts>} command to set the voltage. 0 turns
545 off the supply. Otherwise, the supply can be set to any value in the range 1800
546 to 3600 millivolts.
547 @* Link: @url{http://processors.wiki.ti.com/index.php/XDS110}
548 @* Link: @url{http://processors.wiki.ti.com/index.php/XDS_Emulation_Software_Package#XDS110_Support_Utilities}
549 @end itemize
550
551 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
552
553 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
554 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
555 these on the market.
556
557 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
558 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
559 of USB-based ones.
560
561 @itemize @bullet
562
563 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
564 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
565
566 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
567 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
568 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
569
570 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
571 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
572
573 @item @b{Wiggler2}
574 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
575
576 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
577 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
578
579 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
580 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
581
582 @item @b{arm-jtag}
583 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
584
585 @item @b{chameleon}
586 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
587
588 @item @b{Triton}
589 @* Unknown.
590
591 @item @b{Lattice}
592 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
593 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
594
595 @item @b{flashlink}
596 @* From STMicroelectronics;
597 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
598
599 @end itemize
600
601 @section Other...
602 @itemize @bullet
603
604 @item @b{ep93xx}
605 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
606
607 @item @b{at91rm9200}
608 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
609
610 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
611 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
612
613 @item @b{imx_gpio}
614 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
615
616 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
617 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
618 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
619
620 @end itemize
621
622 @node About Jim-Tcl
623 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
624 @cindex Jim-Tcl
625 @cindex tcl
626
627 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
628 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
629 command interpreter.
630
631 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
632 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
633 much of anything about Tcl.
634 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
635
636 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
637 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
638 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
639 OpenOCD mailing list.
640
641 @itemize @bullet
642 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
643 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
644 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
645 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
646 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
647 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
648
649 @item @b{Missing Features}
650 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
651 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
652 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
653 enabled in OpenOCD.
654
655 @item @b{Scripts}
656 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
657 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
658 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
659
660 @item @b{Commands}
661 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
662 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
663 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
664 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
665
666 @item @b{Historical Note}
667 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
668 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
669 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
670 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
671
672 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
673 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
674 @end itemize
675
676 @node Running
677 @chapter Running
678 @cindex command line options
679 @cindex logfile
680 @cindex directory search
681
682 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
683 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
684 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
685 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
686 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
687 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
688 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
689
690 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
691 tell it how each debug session should work.
692 The @option{--help} option shows:
693 @verbatim
694 bash$ openocd --help
695
696 --help | -h display this help
697 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
698 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
699 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
700 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
701 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
702 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
703 --command | -c run <command>
704 @end verbatim
705
706 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
707 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
708 To specify one or more different
709 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
710
711 @example
712 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
713 @end example
714
715 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
716 @enumerate
717 @item the current directory,
718 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
719 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
720 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd} (not on Windows),
721 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
722 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
723 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
724 @end enumerate
725 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
726
727 @quotation Note
728 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
729 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
730 @end quotation
731
732 @section Simple setup, no customization
733
734 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
735 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
736 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
737 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
738 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
739
740 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
741 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
742 the server with some variation of one of the following:
743
744 @example
745 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
746 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
747 @end example
748
749 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
750 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
751 If all goes well you'll see output something like
752
753 @example
754 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
755 For bug reports, read
756 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
757 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
758 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
759 @end example
760
761 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
762 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
763 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
764
765 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
766
767 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
768 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
769 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
770 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
771 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
772 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
773 ensure that this always succeeds.
774 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
775 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
776 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
777 and then shut down without acting as a server.
778
779 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
780 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
781 those channels.
782
783 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
784 the @option{-d} option.
785
786 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
787 @option{-c} command line switch.
788
789 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
790 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
791 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
792 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
793 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
794 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
795 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
796
797 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
798 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
799
800 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
801 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
802 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
803 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
804
805 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
806 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
807
808 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
809 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
810 and start the OpenOCD server.
811 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
812 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
813 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
814 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
815
816 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
817
818 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
819 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
820 and a USB cable on the other.
821 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
822 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
823
824 @enumerate
825 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
826 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
827 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
828 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
829 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
830 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
831 debugging host.
832
833 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
834 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
835 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
836 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
837 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
838
839 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
840 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
841 with 1.2 Volt boards.
842
843 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
844 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
845 ways to connect the cable.
846 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
847 Be sure it's firmly connected.
848
849 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
850 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
851 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
852 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
853 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
854 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
855 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
856 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
857
858 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
859 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
860 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
861 but are tedious to set up.
862 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
863 adapter signals to the right board pins.
864
865 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
866 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
867 you are using to run OpenOCD.
868 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
869
870 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
871 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
872 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
873 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
874
875 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
876 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
877 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
878
879 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
880 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
881 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
882 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
883
884 @end enumerate
885
886 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
887 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
888 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
889
890 @section Project Directory
891
892 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
893
894 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
895 single directory for your work with a given board.
896 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
897 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
898 files accessed through semihosting,
899 and for code you upload to the target board.
900 It is also the natural place to write files,
901 such as log files and data you download from the board.
902
903 @section Configuration Basics
904
905 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
906 a variety of ways you can mix them.
907 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
908
909 @itemize
910 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
911 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
912 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
913 @end itemize
914
915 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
916 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
917 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
918
919 @example
920 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
921
922 # GDB can also flash my flash!
923 gdb_memory_map enable
924 gdb_flash_program enable
925
926 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
927 @end example
928
929 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
930
931 @example
932 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
933 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
934 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
935 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
936 @end example
937
938 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
939 each supporting a different development task.
940 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
941 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
942
943 @quotation Important
944 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
945 problems with how it treats variables.
946 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
947 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
948 that can be tested in a later script.
949 @end quotation
950
951 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
952 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
953 to simplify your work.
954
955 @section User Config Files
956 @cindex config file, user
957 @cindex user config file
958 @cindex config file, overview
959
960 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
961 in one place.
962 One of the following will match your situation best:
963
964 @itemize
965 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
966 provided by someone else.
967 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
968 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
969 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
970 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
971 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
972 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
973
974 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
975 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
976
977 @enumerate
978 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
979 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
980 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
981 @end enumerate
982
983 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
984 The first is an interface config file.
985 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
986 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
987 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
988 meet your deadline:
989
990 @example
991 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
992 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
993 @end example
994
995 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
996 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
997 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
998 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
999
1000 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
1001 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
1002 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
1003 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
1004 target and board
1005 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
1006 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
1007
1008 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
1009 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1010 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1011 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1012
1013 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1014 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1015 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1016 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1017 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1018
1019 @quotation Note
1020 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1021 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1022 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1023 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1024 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1025 @end quotation
1026
1027 @item
1028 You may may need to write some C code.
1029 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1030 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1031 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1032 a new chip architecture.
1033 @end itemize
1034
1035 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1036 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1037 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1038
1039 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1040 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1041 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1042 @itemize
1043
1044 @item
1045 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1046 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1047 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1048 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1049
1050 @item
1051 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1052 @cindex vector_catch
1053 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1054 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1055 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1056 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1057 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1058 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1059
1060 @item
1061 You might need to override some defaults.
1062 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1063 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1064
1065 @item
1066 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1067 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1068 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1069 @end itemize
1070
1071 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1072
1073 A few project-specific utility
1074 routines may well speed up your work.
1075 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1076
1077 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1078 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1079 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1080 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1081 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1082 may help:
1083
1084 @example
1085 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1086 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1087 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1088 # Leave the CPU halted.
1089 reset init
1090
1091 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1092 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1093
1094 # Start running.
1095 resume 0x20000000
1096 @}
1097 @end example
1098
1099 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1100 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1101 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1102 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1103 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1104
1105 @example
1106 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1107 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1108 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1109 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1110 reset init
1111
1112 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1113 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1114 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1115 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1116 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1117 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1118 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1119
1120 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1121 reset run
1122 @}
1123 @end example
1124
1125 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1126 from NAND.
1127 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1128 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1129 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1130
1131 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1132 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1133
1134 @section Target Software Changes
1135
1136 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1137 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1138 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1139 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1140 handling issues like:
1141
1142 @itemize @bullet
1143
1144 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1145 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1146 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1147 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1148 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1149 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1150 your debug sessions.
1151
1152 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1153 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1154 That might however be your only option.
1155
1156 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1157 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1158 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1159 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1160 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1161 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1162 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1163 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1164 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1165 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1166 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1167 instead of the whole thing.
1168 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1169 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1170
1171 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1172 @cindex ARM semihosting
1173 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1174 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1175 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1176 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1177 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1178 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1179 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1180 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1181 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1182 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1183 NAND or SPI flash.
1184
1185 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1186 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1187 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1188 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1189 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1190
1191 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1192 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1193 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1194 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1195 registers which can be used to change various features including
1196 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1197 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1198 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1199 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1200 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1201
1202 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1203 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1204 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1205 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1206 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1207
1208 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1209 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1210 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1211 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1212 early code execution can be debugged
1213 or firmware can be replaced.
1214
1215 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1216 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1217 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1218 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1219 operations like writing to memory.)
1220
1221 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1222 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1223 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1224 various kinds of message.
1225 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1226
1227 @end itemize
1228
1229 @section Target Hardware Setup
1230
1231 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1232 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1233 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1234 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1235 working with.}
1236
1237 Common issues include:
1238
1239 @itemize @bullet
1240
1241 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1242 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1243 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1244 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1245 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1246 or one from a daughtercard).
1247 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1248 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1249
1250 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1251 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1252 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1253 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1254 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1255 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1256
1257 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1258 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1259 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1260 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1261 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1262
1263
1264 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1265 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1266 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1267 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1268 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1269 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1270 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1271
1272 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1273 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1274 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1275 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1276 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1277
1278 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1279 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1280 used to start booting.
1281
1282 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1283 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1284 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1285 multiple audio codec chips).
1286 This interacts with software
1287 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1288 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1289 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1290 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1291 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1292 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1293 audio or video codecs are used.
1294
1295 @end itemize
1296
1297 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1298 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1299 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1300 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1301 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1302 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1303 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1304 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1305 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1306 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1307
1308
1309 @node Config File Guidelines
1310 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1311
1312 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1313 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1314 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1315 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1316
1317 You should find the following directories under
1318 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1319 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1320 @itemize @bullet
1321 @item @file{interface} ...
1322 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1323 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1324 @item @file{board} ...
1325 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1326 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1327
1328 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1329 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1330 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1331 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1332 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1333 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1334 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1335 a CPU and an FPGA.
1336 @item @file{target} ...
1337 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1338 on a chip
1339 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1340 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1341 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1342 the target config file defines all of them.
1343 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1344 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1345 @end itemize
1346
1347 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1348 file may override features in any of the above files by
1349 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1350 commands specific to their situation.
1351
1352 @section Interface Config Files
1353
1354 The user config file
1355 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1356
1357 @example
1358 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1359 @end example
1360
1361 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1362 in use today with OpenOCD.
1363 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1364 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1365
1366 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1367 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1368 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1369 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1370 and need to provide a driver for it.
1371
1372 @section Board Config Files
1373 @cindex config file, board
1374 @cindex board config file
1375
1376 The user config file
1377 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1378
1379 @example
1380 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1381 @end example
1382
1383 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1384 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1385 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1386
1387 @enumerate
1388 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1389 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1390 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1391 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1392 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1393 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1394 @end enumerate
1395
1396 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1397 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1398 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1399 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1400
1401 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1402 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1403 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1404 configuration works.
1405
1406 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1407
1408 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1409 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1410 convention on how to use certain variables.
1411
1412 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1413 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1414 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1415 used at will within a target configuration file.
1416
1417 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1418 for a board with three chips:
1419
1420 @example
1421 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1422 set CHIPNAME network
1423 set ENDIAN big
1424 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1425 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1426 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1427 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1428
1429 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1430 set CHIPNAME video
1431 set ENDIAN little
1432 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1433 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1434 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1435 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1436
1437 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1438 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1439 unset ENDIAN
1440 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1441 @end example
1442
1443 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1444 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1445 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1446 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1447 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1448 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1449 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1450 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1451
1452 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1453 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1454 naming collisions.
1455
1456 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1457 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1458 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1459 up other clocks and peripherals.
1460
1461 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1462 @cindex variable names
1463
1464 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1465 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1466 one such chip (as shown above).
1467 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1468 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1469 to promote consistency and
1470 so that board files can override target defaults.
1471
1472 Inputs to target config files include:
1473
1474 @itemize @bullet
1475 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1476 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1477 tap identifier dotted names.
1478 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1479 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1480 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1481 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1482 Chips that can't change endianess don't need to use this variable.
1483 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1484 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1485 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1486 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1487 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1488 @end itemize
1489
1490 Outputs from target config files include:
1491
1492 @itemize @bullet
1493 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1494 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1495 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1496 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1497 specific to that board and that target.
1498 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1499 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1500 @end itemize
1501
1502 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1503 @cindex event, reset-init
1504 @cindex reset-init handler
1505
1506 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1507 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1508 fully set up yet.
1509 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1510 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1511 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1512 handler is one of the most important.
1513
1514 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1515 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1516 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1517 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1518 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1519
1520 @quotation Note
1521 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1522 are included here.
1523 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1524 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1525 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1526 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1527 @end quotation
1528
1529 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1530 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1531 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1532 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1533 those as parameters.
1534 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1535 and disabling the watchdog.
1536 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1537 the next developer doing such work.
1538 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1539
1540 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1541 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1542 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1543 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1544
1545 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1546
1547 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1548 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1549 a low JTAG clock rate.
1550 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1551 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1552 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1553 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1554 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1555 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1556 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1557
1558 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1559 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1560 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1561 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1562 which might be less than that.
1563
1564 @quotation Warning
1565 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1566 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1567 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1568 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1569 @end quotation
1570
1571 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1572 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1573 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1574 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter_khz}.
1575 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1576 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1577
1578 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1579 @subsection The init_board procedure
1580 @cindex init_board procedure
1581
1582 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1583 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1584 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1585 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1586 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1587 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1588 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1589 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1590 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1591 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1592 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1593 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1594
1595 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1596 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1597
1598 @example
1599 ### board_file.cfg ###
1600
1601 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1602 source [find target/target.cfg]
1603
1604 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1605 # enables fast on-board clock source
1606 # configures the chip to use it
1607 @}
1608
1609 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1610 proc init_board @{@} @{
1611 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1612
1613 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1614 adapter_khz 100
1615 @}
1616
1617 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1618 enable_fast_clock
1619 adapter_khz 10000
1620 @}
1621 @}
1622 @end example
1623
1624 @section Target Config Files
1625 @cindex config file, target
1626 @cindex target config file
1627
1628 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1629 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1630 more target config files like this:
1631
1632 @example
1633 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1634 @end example
1635
1636 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1637 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1638 In summary the target files should contain
1639
1640 @enumerate
1641 @item Set defaults
1642 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1643 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1644 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1645 @item On-Chip flash
1646 @end enumerate
1647
1648 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1649 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1650 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1651
1652 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1653 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1654 can talk to the chip.
1655 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1656 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1657 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1658 and other processing engines.
1659
1660 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1661
1662 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1663 letting board config files express environment-specific
1664 differences in how things should be set up.
1665
1666 @example
1667 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1668 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1669 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1670 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1671 @} else @{
1672 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1673 @}
1674
1675 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1676 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1677 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1678 @} else @{
1679 set _ENDIAN little
1680 @}
1681
1682 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1683 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1684 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1685 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1686 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1687 @} else @{
1688 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1689 @}
1690 @end example
1691 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1692
1693 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1694 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1695 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1696
1697 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1698 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1699 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1700
1701 @example
1702 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1703 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1704 @end example
1705
1706 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1707 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1708 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1709 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1710 for taps.
1711
1712 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1713 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1714 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1715 looks (in part) like this:
1716
1717 @example
1718 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1719 @end example
1720
1721 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1722 to source such a config file twice, with different
1723 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1724 it adds a different TAP each time.
1725
1726 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1727 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1728 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1729 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1730
1731 @example
1732 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1733 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1734 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1735 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1736 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1737 @end example
1738
1739 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1740 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1741
1742 @itemize
1743 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1744 plus a JRC to enable them
1745 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1746 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1747 is not currently used)
1748 @end itemize
1749
1750 @subsection Add CPU targets
1751
1752 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1753 GDB and other commands can use it.
1754 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1755 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1756 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1757 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1758
1759 @example
1760 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1761 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1762 @end example
1763
1764 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1765 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1766 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1767 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1768 a work area if you can.
1769 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1770
1771 @example
1772 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1773 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1774 @end example
1775
1776 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1777 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1778 @cindex SMP
1779 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1780
1781 @example
1782 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1783 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1784 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1785 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1786 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1787 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1788 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1789 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1790 @end example
1791 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1792 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1793 @itemize @bullet
1794 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1795 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1796 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1797 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1798 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1799 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1800 @end itemize
1801
1802 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1803 command have been implemented.
1804 @itemize @bullet
1805 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1806 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1807 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1808 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1809 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1810 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1811 following example.
1812 @end itemize
1813
1814 @example
1815 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1816 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1817 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1818 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1819 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1820 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1821 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1822 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1823 > resume
1824 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1825 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1826 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1827 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1828 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1829 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1830 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1831 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1832 @end example
1833
1834
1835 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1836
1837 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1838 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1839 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1840
1841 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1842 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1843 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1844 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1845 both signals.
1846
1847 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1848 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1849 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1850 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1851 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1852 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1853 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1854 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1855 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1856 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1857 not available.)
1858
1859 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1860 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1861 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1862 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1863 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1864 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1865 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1866 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1867
1868 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1869 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1870 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1871 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1872 slower clock than they will use later.
1873 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1874 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1875 than they will use later.
1876 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1877
1878 @quotation Important
1879 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1880 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1881 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1882 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1883 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1884 @end quotation
1885
1886 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1887 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1888 @cindex init_targets procedure
1889
1890 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1891 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1892 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1893 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1894 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1895 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1896 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1897 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1898 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1899
1900 @example
1901 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1902
1903 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1904 # basic initialization procedure ...
1905 @}
1906
1907 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1908 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1909 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1910 @}
1911
1912 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1913
1914 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1915
1916 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1917 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1918 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1919 @}
1920 @end example
1921
1922 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1923 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1924
1925 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1926
1927 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1928 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1929
1930 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1931 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1932 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1933
1934 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1935 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1936 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1937 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1938 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1939 events already assigned.
1940
1941 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1942
1943 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1944 special high speed download features - enable it.
1945
1946 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1947
1948 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1949 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1950 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1951 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1952 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1953 If you are using an external trace port,
1954 configure it in your board config file.
1955 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1956 configure it in your target config file.
1957
1958 @example
1959 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1960 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1961 @end example
1962
1963 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1964
1965 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1966
1967 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1968 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1969 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1970 the TARGET (chip) file.
1971
1972 Examples:
1973 @itemize @bullet
1974 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1975 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1976 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1977 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1978 @end itemize
1979
1980 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1981 @section Translating Configuration Files
1982 @cindex translation
1983 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1984 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1985 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1986 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1987 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1988 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1989
1990 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1991 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1992 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1993 convert other scripts later on.
1994
1995 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1996 replace job:
1997
1998 @example
1999 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
2000 #
2001 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
2002 #
2003 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
2004 #
2005 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
2006
2007 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
2008 global TARGETNAME
2009
2010 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2011
2012 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2013 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2014 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2015 @}
2016 @end example
2017
2018
2019
2020 @node Server Configuration
2021 @chapter Server Configuration
2022 @cindex initialization
2023 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2024 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2025 supported.
2026
2027 @anchor{configurationstage}
2028 @section Configuration Stage
2029 @cindex configuration stage
2030 @cindex config command
2031
2032 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2033 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2034 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2035 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2036 inside startup scripts.
2037
2038 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2039 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2040 which may be issued interactively.
2041 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2042 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2043
2044 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2045 flash banks,
2046 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2047 and other basic setup.
2048 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2049 may access or activate TAPs.
2050 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2051 longer be issued.
2052
2053 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2054 @section Entering the Run Stage
2055
2056 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2057 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2058 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2059 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2060 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2061 You should see no errors at this point.
2062 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2063 commands you used to configure the server.
2064 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2065 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2066 on the scan chain.
2067
2068 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2069 become available.
2070 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2071 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2072 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2073 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2074 entry to the run stage.
2075
2076 @deffn {Config Command} init
2077 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2078 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2079 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2080 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2081 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2082 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2083
2084 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2085 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2086 configuration files and/or command line options.
2087
2088 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2089 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2090 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2091 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2092 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2093 @end deffn
2094
2095 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2096 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2097 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2098
2099 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2100 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2101 scan chain.
2102 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2103 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2104
2105 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2106 they return.
2107 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2108 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2109 @end deffn
2110
2111 @anchor{tcpipports}
2112 @section TCP/IP Ports
2113 @cindex TCP port
2114 @cindex server
2115 @cindex port
2116 @cindex security
2117 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2118 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2119 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2120
2121 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2122 access using one or more of these ports.
2123 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2124 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2125 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2126
2127 @anchor{gdb_port}
2128 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2129 @cindex GDB server
2130 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2131 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2132 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2133 the normal use cases.
2134
2135 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2136 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2137 disables the gdb server.
2138
2139 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2140 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2141
2142 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2143 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2144
2145 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2146 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2147 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2148
2149 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2150 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2151 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2152 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2153 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2154 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2155 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2156 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2157 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2158
2159 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2160 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2161 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2162 @end deffn
2163
2164 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2165 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2166 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2167 output from the Tcl engine.
2168 Intended as a machine interface.
2169 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2170 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2171 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2172 @end deffn
2173
2174 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2175 Specify or query the
2176 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2177 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2178 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2179 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2180 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2181 @end deffn
2182
2183 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2184 @section GDB Configuration
2185 @cindex GDB
2186 @cindex GDB configuration
2187 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2188 The ones listed here are static and global.
2189 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2190 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2191
2192 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2193 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2194 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2195 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2196 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2197 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2198 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2199 @end deffn
2200
2201 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2202 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2203 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2204 vFlash packet is received.
2205 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2206 @end deffn
2207
2208 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2209 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2210 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2211 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2212 for flash programming to work.
2213 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2214 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2215 @end deffn
2216
2217 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2218 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2219 by GDB memory read packets.
2220 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2221 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2222 @end deffn
2223
2224 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_register_access_error (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2225 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2226 packets report errors or not.
2227 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2228 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2229 @end deffn
2230
2231 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2232 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2233 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2234 @end deffn
2235
2236 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2237 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2238
2239 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2240 @end deffn
2241
2242 @anchor{eventpolling}
2243 @section Event Polling
2244
2245 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2246 where significant events can happen at any time.
2247 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2248 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2249 or to GDB.
2250
2251 Examples of such events include:
2252
2253 @itemize
2254 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2255 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2256 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2257 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2258 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2259 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2260 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2261 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2262 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2263 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2264 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2265 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2266 @end itemize
2267
2268 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2269 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2270 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2271 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2272 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2273
2274 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2275 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2276 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2277 to the various active targets.
2278 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2279 which is normally done in the background.
2280
2281 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2282 Poll the current target for its current state.
2283 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2284 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2285 specific information about the current state is printed.
2286 An optional parameter
2287 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2288
2289 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2290 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2291 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2292 @example
2293 > poll
2294 background polling: on
2295 target state: halted
2296 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2297 current mode: Supervisor
2298 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2299 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2300 >
2301 @end example
2302 @end deffn
2303
2304 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2305 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2306 @cindex config file, interface
2307 @cindex interface config file
2308
2309 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2310 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2311 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2312
2313 @quotation Note
2314 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2315 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2316 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2317 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2318 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2319 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2320 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2321 @end quotation
2322
2323 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2324 through commands in an interface configuration
2325 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2326 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2327
2328 @example
2329 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2330 @end example
2331
2332 These commands tell
2333 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2334 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2335
2336 @example
2337 # jlink interface
2338 interface jlink
2339 @end example
2340
2341 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2342
2343
2344 @section Interface Configuration
2345
2346 The interface command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2347 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2348 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2349
2350 @deffn {Config Command} {interface} name
2351 Use the interface driver @var{name} to connect to the
2352 target.
2353 @end deffn
2354
2355 @deffn Command {interface_list}
2356 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2357 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2358 @end deffn
2359 @deffn Command {interface transports} transport_name+
2360 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2361 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2362 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2363 the hardware can support.
2364 @end deffn
2365
2366
2367
2368 @deffn Command {adapter_name}
2369 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2370 @end deffn
2371
2372 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2373 @deffn Command {adapter usb location} <bus>-<port>[.<port>]...
2374 Specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2375 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2376 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2377 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2378 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2379
2380 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2381 @end deffn
2382
2383 @section Interface Drivers
2384
2385 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2386 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2387 available at run time.
2388
2389 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2390 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2391 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2392 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2393
2394 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2395 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2396 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2397 @end deffn
2398
2399 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2400 Displays status of RTCK option.
2401 Optionally sets that option first.
2402 @end deffn
2403 @end deffn
2404
2405 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2406 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2407 This has one driver-specific command:
2408
2409 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2410 Logs some status
2411 @end deffn
2412 @end deffn
2413
2414 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2415 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2416 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2417 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2418 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2419 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2420 @end deffn
2421
2422 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2423 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter.
2424
2425 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2426 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2427 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2428 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2429 @example
2430 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2431 @end example
2432 @end deffn
2433
2434 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2435 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2436 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2437 @end deffn
2438
2439 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2440 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2441 @end deffn
2442 @end deffn
2443
2444 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2445 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2446 @end deffn
2447
2448 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2449 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2450 @end deffn
2451
2452 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2453 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2454 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2455
2456 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2457 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi or D2XX.
2458
2459 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2460 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2461
2462 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2463 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2464 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2465 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2466 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2467 @command{ftdi_get_signal} command.
2468
2469 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2470 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2471 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2472 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2473 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2474
2475 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2476 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2477 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2478 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2479
2480 @itemize @minus
2481 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2482 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2483 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2484 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2485 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2486 switching data and direction as necessary
2487 @end itemize
2488
2489 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2490 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2491
2492 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2493 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2494 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2495 @example
2496 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2497 @end example
2498 @end deffn
2499
2500 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2501 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2502 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2503 during device selection.
2504 @end deffn
2505
2506 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2507 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2508 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2509 is connected to the host.
2510 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2511 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2512 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2513 @end deffn
2514
2515 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_location} <bus>-<port>[.<port>]...
2516 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
2517 Use the command @ref{adapter_usb_location,,adapter usb location} instead.}
2518
2519 Specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2520 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2521 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2522 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2523 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t}.
2524
2525 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2526 @end deffn
2527
2528 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2529 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2530 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2531 @end deffn
2532
2533 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2534 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2535 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2536 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2537 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2538 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2539 and initially asserted reset signals.
2540 @end deffn
2541
2542 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2543 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2544 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2545 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2546 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2547 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2548 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2549 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2550 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2551 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2552 with the method @command{ftdi_get_signal}.
2553
2554 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2555 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2556 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2557 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2558 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2559 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2560
2561 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2562 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2563 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2564 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2565 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2566 are always driven by the FTDI.
2567
2568 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2569 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2570 @var{name}.
2571 @end deffn
2572
2573 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2574 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2575 @itemize @minus
2576 @item @option{0}, drive low
2577 @item @option{1}, drive high
2578 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2579 @end itemize
2580 @end deffn
2581
2582 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_get_signal} name
2583 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2584 @end deffn
2585
2586 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2587 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2588
2589 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2590 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2591 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2592 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2593 @itemize @minus
2594 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2595 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2596 @end itemize
2597 @end deffn
2598
2599 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2600 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2601
2602 @end deffn
2603
2604 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2605 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2606 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2607 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2608
2609 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2610 @itemize @minus
2611 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2612 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2613 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2614 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2615 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2616 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2617 @end itemize
2618
2619 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2620 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2621 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2622 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2623 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2624 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2625 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2626 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2627
2628 FT232R
2629 @itemize @minus
2630 @item bit 7 - RI
2631 @item bit 6 - DCD
2632 @item bit 5 - DSR
2633 @item bit 4 - DTR
2634 @item bit 3 - CTS
2635 @item bit 2 - RTS
2636 @item bit 1 - RXD
2637 @item bit 0 - TXD
2638 @end itemize
2639
2640 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2641 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2642
2643 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2644 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2645 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2646 @end deffn
2647
2648 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_serial_desc} @var{serial}
2649 Specifies the @var{serial} of the adapter to use, in case the
2650 vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter is connected to
2651 the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2652 @end deffn
2653
2654 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2655 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2656 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2657 @end deffn
2658
2659 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tck_num} @var{tck}
2660 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2661 @end deffn
2662
2663 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tms_num} @var{tms}
2664 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2665 @end deffn
2666
2667 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2668 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2669 @end deffn
2670
2671 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2672 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2673 @end deffn
2674
2675 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_trst_num} @var{trst}
2676 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2677 @end deffn
2678
2679 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_srst_num} @var{srst}
2680 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2681 @end deffn
2682
2683 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_restore_serial} @var{word}
2684 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2685 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2686 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2687 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2688 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2689 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2690 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2691 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2692 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2693 @end deffn
2694
2695 @end deffn
2696
2697 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2698 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2699 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2700 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2701
2702 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2703 processors which are being simulated.
2704
2705 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2706 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2707 sockets instead of TCP.
2708 @end deffn
2709
2710 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2711 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2712 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2713 @end deffn
2714
2715 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2716 something like:
2717
2718 @example
2719 interface remote_bitbang
2720 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2721 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2722 @end example
2723
2724 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2725 named mysocket:
2726
2727 @example
2728 interface remote_bitbang
2729 remote_bitbang_port 0
2730 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2731 @end example
2732 @end deffn
2733
2734 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2735 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2736 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2737 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2738
2739 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2740 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2741 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2742 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2743 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2744 @end deffn
2745
2746 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2747 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2748 default values are used.
2749 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2750 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2751 @example
2752 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2753 @end example
2754 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2755 @example
2756 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2757 @end example
2758 @end deffn
2759
2760 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2761 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2762 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2763 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2764 target board.
2765
2766 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2767 @example
2768 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2769 reset_config srst_only
2770 @end example
2771 @end deffn
2772
2773 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2774 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2775 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2776 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2777 @end deffn
2778
2779 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2780 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2781 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2782 @end deffn
2783
2784 @end deffn
2785
2786 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2787 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2788 This has one driver-specific command:
2789
2790 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2791 Display either the address of the I/O port
2792 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2793 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2794 This is a write-once setting.
2795 @end deffn
2796 @end deffn
2797
2798 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2799 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2800 transports.
2801
2802 @quotation Compatibility Note
2803 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2804 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2805 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2806 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2807 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2808 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2809 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2810 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2811 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2812 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2813 @end quotation
2814
2815 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2816 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2817 states.
2818 @end deffn
2819 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2820 Display free device internal memory.
2821 @end deffn
2822 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2823 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2824 command version.
2825 @end deffn
2826 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2827 Display the device configuration.
2828 @end deffn
2829 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2830 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2831 power state.
2832 @end deffn
2833 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2834 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2835 @end deffn
2836 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2837 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2838 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2839 IP configuration.
2840 @end deffn
2841 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2842 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2843 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2844 @end deffn
2845 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2846 Reset the current configuration.
2847 @end deffn
2848 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2849 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2850 @end deffn
2851 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write <channel> <data>}
2852 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2853 pairs.
2854
2855 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2856 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2857 @example
2858 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2859 @end example
2860 @end deffn
2861 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read <channel> <length>}
2862 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2863 pairs.
2864
2865 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2866 @example
2867 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2868 77a90000
2869 @end example
2870 @end deffn
2871 @deffn {Config} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2872 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2873 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2874 selection via USB address is deprecated and the serial number should be used
2875 instead.
2876
2877 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2878 @end deffn
2879 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2880 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2881 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2882
2883 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2884 @end deffn
2885 @end deffn
2886
2887 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2888 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2889 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2890 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2891 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2892 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2893 configuration script.
2894
2895 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2896 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2897 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2898 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2899 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2900
2901 Known limitations:
2902 @itemize @bullet
2903 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2904 and 2.7 MHz.
2905 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2906 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2907 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2908 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2909 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2910 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2911 communications with the target.
2912 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2913 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2914 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2915 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2916 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2917 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2918 @end itemize
2919
2920 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2921 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2922 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2923 @end deffn
2924
2925 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_serial} serial
2926 Select a KitProg device by its @var{serial}. If left unspecified, the first
2927 device detected by OpenOCD will be used.
2928 @end deffn
2929
2930 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2931 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2932 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2933 target as a side-effect.
2934 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2935 @end deffn
2936
2937 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2938 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2939 version, and target voltage.
2940 @end deffn
2941 @end deffn
2942
2943 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2944 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2945 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2946 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2947 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2948
2949 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2950 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2951 This is a write-once setting.
2952 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2953
2954 @itemize @minus
2955 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2956 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2957 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2958 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2959 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2960 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2961 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2962 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2963 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2964 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2965 some versions of
2966 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2967 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2968 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2969 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2970 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2971 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2972 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2973 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2974 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2975 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2976 @end itemize
2977 @end deffn
2978
2979 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2980 Display either the address of the I/O port
2981 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2982 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2983 This is a write-once setting.
2984
2985 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2986 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
2987 you may encounter a problem.
2988 @end deffn
2989
2990 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2991 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2992 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2993 @command{adapter_khz} configuration.
2994 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2995 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2996
2997 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2998 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2999 @quotation Tip
3000 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
3001 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
3002 @example
3003 > parport_toggling_time 1000
3004 > adapter_khz 500
3005 @end example
3006 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
3007 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
3008 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
3009 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
3010 large set of samples.
3011 Update the setting to match your measurement:
3012 @example
3013 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
3014 @end example
3015 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter_khz rate}
3016 commands given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3017
3018 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3019 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3020 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3021 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3022 match for the adapter_khz rate you specified; be conservative.
3023 @end quotation
3024 @end deffn
3025
3026 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3027 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3028 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3029 @end deffn
3030
3031 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3032 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3033
3034 @example
3035 interface parport
3036 parport_port 0x278
3037 parport_cable wiggler
3038 @end example
3039 @end deffn
3040
3041 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3042 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3043 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
3044 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
3045 @end deffn
3046 @end deffn
3047
3048 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3049 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3050 @end deffn
3051
3052 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3053 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3054 @end deffn
3055
3056 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3057 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3058
3059 @quotation Note
3060 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3061 which are not currently documented here.
3062 @end quotation
3063 @end deffn
3064
3065 @anchor{hla_interface}
3066 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3067 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3068 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3069 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3070
3071 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK and TI ICDI.
3072 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3073 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3074 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3075 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3076
3077 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3078 Currently Not Supported.
3079 @end deffn
3080
3081 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
3082 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3083 @end deffn
3084
3085 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi})
3086 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3087 @end deffn
3088
3089 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3090 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3091 @end deffn
3092
3093 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3094 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3095 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3096 @end deffn
3097 @end deffn
3098
3099 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3100 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3101 @end deffn
3102
3103 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3104 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3105 @end deffn
3106
3107 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
3108 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
3109 @end deffn
3110
3111 @quotation Note
3112 This defines some driver-specific commands,
3113 which are not currently documented here.
3114 @end quotation
3115
3116 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
3117 Turn power switch to target on/off.
3118 No arguments: print status.
3119 @end deffn
3120
3121 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3122 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3123 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3124
3125 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3126 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3127 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3128 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3129 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3130 configuration on exit.
3131
3132 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3133 pinout.
3134
3135 @end deffn
3136
3137 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3138 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3139 of the one which is most popular.
3140
3141 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3142
3143 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3144 pinout.
3145
3146 @end deffn
3147
3148
3149 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3150 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3151 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3152
3153 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_variant} variant
3154 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3155 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3156
3157 @itemize @minus
3158 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3159 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3160 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3161 @end itemize
3162 @end deffn
3163
3164 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_device_desc} string
3165 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3166 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3167 @end deffn
3168 @end deffn
3169
3170 @section Transport Configuration
3171 @cindex Transport
3172 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3173 and the debug adapter you are using,
3174 several transports may be available to
3175 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3176 @deffn Command {transport list}
3177 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3178 version of OpenOCD.
3179 @end deffn
3180
3181 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3182 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3183
3184 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3185 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3186 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3187 adapter's driver).
3188
3189 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3190 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3191 supported by the debug adapter.
3192
3193 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3194 transport, if any.
3195 @end deffn
3196
3197 @subsection JTAG Transport
3198 @cindex JTAG
3199 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3200 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3201 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3202 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3203 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3204 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3205
3206 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3207 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3208 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3209 hla_jtag}.
3210
3211 @subsection SWD Transport
3212 @cindex SWD
3213 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3214 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3215 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3216 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3217 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3218 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3219 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3220
3221 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3222 swd}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3223 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3224 hla_swd}.
3225
3226 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3227 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3228 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3229 expected to change.
3230 @end deffn
3231 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3232 Updates TRN (turnaround delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3233 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3234 No parameters: displays current settings.
3235 @end deffn
3236
3237 @subsection SPI Transport
3238 @cindex SPI
3239 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3240 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3241 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3242 solution for flash programming.
3243
3244 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3245 @section JTAG Speed
3246 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3247 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3248 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3249 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3250 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3251 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3252 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3253 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3254 power management software that may be active.
3255
3256 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3257 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3258 target event handler.
3259 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3260 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3261 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3262 sets up those clocks).
3263 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3264 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3265 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3266 in the target config file.
3267 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3268 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3269 config file instead.
3270 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3271 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3272 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3273
3274 @example
3275 jtag_rclk 3000
3276 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3277 @end example
3278
3279 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3280 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3281 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3282 may not be the fastest solution.
3283
3284 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3285 instead of @command{adapter_khz}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3286 which support adaptive clocking.
3287
3288 @deffn {Command} adapter_khz max_speed_kHz
3289 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3290 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3291 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3292 than the speed specified.
3293
3294 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3295 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3296 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3297 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3298
3299 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3300 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3301 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3302 JTAG clocking after setup.
3303 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3304 If the interface device can not
3305 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3306 @end deffn
3307
3308 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3309 @cindex adaptive clocking
3310 @cindex RTCK
3311 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3312 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3313 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3314 @example
3315 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3316 jtag_rclk 3000
3317 @end example
3318 @end defun
3319
3320 @node Reset Configuration
3321 @chapter Reset Configuration
3322 @cindex Reset Configuration
3323
3324 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3325 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3326 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3327 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3328 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3329 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3330 Please see the various board files for examples.
3331
3332 @quotation Note
3333 To maintainers and integrators:
3334 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3335 Normally the board configuration file
3336 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3337 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3338
3339 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3340 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3341 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3342 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3343 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3344 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3345 @end quotation
3346
3347 @section Types of Reset
3348
3349 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3350 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3351 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3352
3353 @itemize @bullet
3354 @item
3355 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3356 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3357 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3358 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3359 @item
3360 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3361 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3362 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3363 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3364 @item
3365 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3366 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3367 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3368 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3369 @item
3370 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3371 several other types of reset.
3372 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3373 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3374 There may be individual module resets.
3375 @end itemize
3376
3377 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3378 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3379 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3380 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3381 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3382 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3383 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3384 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3385 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3386
3387 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3388 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3389
3390 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3391 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3392 common issues are:
3393
3394 @itemize @bullet
3395
3396 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3397 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3398 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3399 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3400 when either of those signals is not connected.
3401 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3402 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3403 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3404 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3405
3406 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3407 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3408 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3409 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3410
3411 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3412 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3413 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3414 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3415 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3416 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3417 hardware debouncing.
3418 Use the @command{adapter_nsrst_delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3419 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3420
3421 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3422 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3423 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3424 to use push/pull output drivers.
3425 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3426 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3427 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3428 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3429
3430 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3431 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3432 issues (not limited to errata).
3433 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3434 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3435 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3436 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3437 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3438 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3439 @end itemize
3440
3441 There can also be other issues.
3442 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3443 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3444 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3445 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3446 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3447 Agreement (NDA).
3448
3449 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3450 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3451 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3452
3453 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3454 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3455
3456 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3457
3458 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_assert_width milliseconds
3459 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3460 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3461 allowing it to be deasserted.
3462 @end deffn
3463
3464 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_delay milliseconds
3465 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3466 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3467 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3468 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3469 @end deffn
3470
3471 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3472 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3473 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3474 allowing it to be deasserted.
3475 @end deffn
3476
3477 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3478 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3479 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3480 @end deffn
3481
3482 @anchor {reset_config}
3483 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3484 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3485 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3486 configuration scripts.
3487
3488 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3489 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3490 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3491 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3492 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3493 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3494 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3495 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3496
3497 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3498 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3499 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3500 -- may be specified at a time.
3501 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3502 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3503 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3504 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3505 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3506
3507 @itemize
3508 @item
3509 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3510 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3511 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3512 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3513 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3514
3515 @quotation Tip
3516 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3517 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3518 @end quotation
3519
3520 @item
3521 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3522 signal implementations.
3523 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3524 indicating everything behaves normally.
3525 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3526 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3527 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3528 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3529 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3530 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3531 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3532
3533 @item
3534 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3535 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3536 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3537 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3538 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3539 while SRST is asserted.
3540 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3541 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3542
3543 @item
3544 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3545 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3546 is required to use this option.
3547 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3548 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3549 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3550 be asserted before any target connection.
3551 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3552 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3553 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3554 @end itemize
3555
3556 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3557 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3558 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3559 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3560 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3561
3562 @itemize
3563 @item
3564 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3565 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3566 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3567 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3568
3569 @item
3570 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3571 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3572 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3573 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3574 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3575 @end itemize
3576 @end deffn
3577
3578 @section Custom Reset Handling
3579 @cindex events
3580
3581 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3582 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3583 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3584 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3585 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3586 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3587
3588 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3589 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3590 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3591 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3592 want to reset everything at once.
3593
3594 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3595 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3596 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3597 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3598 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3599 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3600 needs special attention.
3601
3602 Experiment with lower level operations, such as @command{jtag_reset}
3603 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3604 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3605 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3606 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3607 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3608 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3609 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3610
3611 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3612 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3613 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3614 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3615 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3616
3617 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3618 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3619 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3620 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3621 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3622 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3623 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3624 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3625 or potentially some other value.
3626
3627 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3628 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3629 operations such as @command{jtag_reset}.
3630 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3631 (or their associated targets)
3632 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3633
3634 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3635 they return.
3636 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3637 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3638 @end deffn
3639
3640 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3641 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3642 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3643 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3644 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3645 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3646 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3647 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3648 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3649 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3650 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3651 @end deffn
3652
3653 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3654 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3655 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3656 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3657 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3658 @end deffn
3659
3660
3661 @node TAP Declaration
3662 @chapter TAP Declaration
3663 @cindex TAP declaration
3664 @cindex TAP configuration
3665
3666 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3667 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3668
3669 @itemize @bullet
3670 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3671 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3672 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3673 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3674 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3675 start running that code.
3676 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3677 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3678 and missing connections.
3679 @end itemize
3680
3681 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3682 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3683 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3684 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3685 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3686
3687 @section Scan Chains
3688 @cindex scan chain
3689
3690 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3691 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3692 They also need to be added to
3693 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3694 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3695 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3696 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3697 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3698 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3699 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3700 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3701
3702 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3703 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3704 command, presented in the next chapter.
3705 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3706 debugging targets.)
3707 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3708
3709 @verbatim
3710 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3711 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3712 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3713 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3714 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3715 @end verbatim
3716
3717 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3718 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3719 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3720 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3721 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3722 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3723 until they are told to do so.
3724
3725 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3726 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3727 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3728 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3729
3730 @example
3731 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3732 @end example
3733
3734 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3735 by a given chip.
3736 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3737 and so forth.
3738 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3739 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3740 both inside a single chip and between them.
3741 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3742
3743 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
3744 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3745 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3746 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3747 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3748 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3749 includes commands something like this:
3750
3751 @example
3752 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3753 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3754 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3755 @end example
3756
3757 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3758 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3759 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3760
3761 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3762 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3763 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3764 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3765 @example
3766 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3767 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3768 @}
3769 @end example
3770 @end deffn
3771
3772 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3773 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3774 and their status.
3775 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3776 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3777 but systems with a JTAG router can
3778 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3779 @end deffn
3780
3781 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3782 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3783
3784 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3785 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3786
3787 @section TAP Names
3788 @cindex dotted name
3789
3790 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3791 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3792 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3793 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3794 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3795 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3796 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3797 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3798
3799 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3800 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3801 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3802
3803 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3804
3805 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3806 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3807 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3808 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3809
3810 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3811 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3812 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3813 overridable.
3814
3815 @cindex TAP naming convention
3816 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3817 and should follow this convention:
3818
3819 @itemize @bullet
3820 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3821 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3822 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3823 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3824 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3825 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3826 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3827 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3828 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3829 with a single TAP;
3830 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3831 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3832 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3833 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3834 @end itemize
3835
3836 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3837
3838 @itemize @bullet
3839 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3840 @*The length in bits of the
3841 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3842 @end itemize
3843
3844 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3845
3846 @itemize @bullet
3847 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3848 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3849 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3850 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3851 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3852 (the TAP is linked in).
3853 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3854 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3855 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3856 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3857 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3858 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3859 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3860 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3861 values that were found but not included in the list.
3862
3863 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3864 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3865 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3866 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3867 hardware to find these values.
3868 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3869 @item @code{-ignore-version}
3870 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
3871 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
3872 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
3873 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
3874 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
3875 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
3876 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
3877 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
3878 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
3879 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
3880 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
3881 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
3882 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
3883 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
3884 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
3885 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
3886 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
3887 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
3888 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
3889 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
3890 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
3891 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
3892 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
3893 @end itemize
3894 @end deffn
3895
3896 @section Other TAP commands
3897
3898 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
3899 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
3900 @end deffn
3901
3902 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
3903 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
3904 At this writing this TAP attribute
3905 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
3906 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
3907 mechanism for debugger targets.)
3908 See the next section for information about the available events.
3909
3910 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
3911 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
3912 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
3913 @end deffn
3914
3915 @section TAP Events
3916 @cindex events
3917 @cindex TAP events
3918
3919 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
3920 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
3921 The other applies to debugger targets,
3922 which are associated with certain TAPs.
3923
3924 The TAP events currently defined are:
3925
3926 @itemize @bullet
3927 @item @b{post-reset}
3928 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
3929 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
3930 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
3931 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
3932 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
3933
3934 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
3935 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
3936 of any particular target.
3937 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
3938 @item @b{setup}
3939 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
3940 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
3941 @item @b{tap-disable}
3942 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
3943 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
3944 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3945 @item @b{tap-enable}
3946 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
3947 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
3948 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3949 @end itemize
3950
3951 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
3952 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
3953 contents to be accurate), you might:
3954
3955 @example
3956 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
3957 echo "JTAG Reset done"
3958 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
3959 @}
3960 @end example
3961
3962
3963 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
3964 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
3965 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
3966 @cindex jrc
3967
3968 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
3969 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
3970 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
3971 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
3972 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
3973
3974 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
3975 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
3976 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
3977 be visible.
3978 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
3979 ignores, such as:
3980
3981 @itemize
3982 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
3983 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
3984 TAPs receive new instructions.
3985 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
3986 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
3987 @end itemize
3988
3989 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
3990 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
3991 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
3992 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
3993
3994 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
3995 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
3996
3997 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
3998 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
3999 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4000 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4001 should define TAP event handlers using
4002 code that looks something like this:
4003
4004 @example
4005 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4006 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4007 @}
4008 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4009 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4010 @}
4011 @end example
4012
4013 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4014
4015 @example
4016 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4017 @end example
4018
4019 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4020 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4021 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4022 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4023
4024 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4025 If necessary, disables the tap
4026 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4027 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4028 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4029 and "0" if it is disabled.
4030 @end deffn
4031
4032 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4033 If necessary, enables the tap
4034 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4035 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4036 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4037 and "0" if it is disabled.
4038 @end deffn
4039
4040 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4041 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4042 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4043 and "0" if it is disabled.
4044
4045 @quotation Note
4046 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4047 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4048 @end quotation
4049 @end deffn
4050
4051 @anchor{autoprobing}
4052 @section Autoprobing
4053 @cindex autoprobe
4054 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4055
4056 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4057 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4058 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4059 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4060
4061 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4062 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4063 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4064 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4065 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4066 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4067 right when they come out of reset).
4068
4069 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4070
4071 @example
4072 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4073 reset_config trst_and_srst
4074 jtag_rclk 8
4075 @end example
4076
4077 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4078 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4079
4080 @enumerate
4081 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4082 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4083 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4084 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4085 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4086 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4087 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4088 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4089 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4090 that is discovered.
4091 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4092 register, it will report it.
4093 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4094 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4095 @end enumerate
4096
4097 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4098 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4099 that's a bit more complex:
4100
4101 @example
4102 clock speed 8 kHz
4103 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4104 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4105 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4106 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4107 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4108 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4109 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4110 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4111 @end example
4112
4113 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4114 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4115 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4116 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4117 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4118 and so forth.
4119
4120 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4121 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4122 @cindex DAP declaration
4123
4124 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4125 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4126 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4127 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4128 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4129
4130 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4131
4132 @deffn Command {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4133 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4134 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4135 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4136 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4137
4138 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4139
4140 @itemize @bullet
4141 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4142 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4143 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4144 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4145 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4146 @end itemize
4147 @end deffn
4148
4149 @deffn Command {dap names}
4150 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4151 for TCL scripting.
4152 @end deffn
4153
4154 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
4155 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4156 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4157 @end deffn
4158
4159 @deffn Command {dap init}
4160 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4161 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4162 initialization, too.
4163 @end deffn
4164
4165 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4166
4167 @deffn Command {$dap_name info} [num]
4168 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4169 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4170 @end deffn
4171
4172 @deffn Command {$dap_name apid} [num]
4173 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4174 @end deffn
4175
4176 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4177 @deffn Command {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4178 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4179 or set a new value @var{value}.
4180 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4181 @end deffn
4182
4183 @deffn Command {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4184 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4185 @end deffn
4186
4187 @deffn Command {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4188 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4189 value @var{value}.
4190
4191 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4192 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4193 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4194
4195 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4196 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4197 @end deffn
4198
4199 @deffn Command {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4200 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4201 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4202 @end deffn
4203
4204 @deffn Command {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4205 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4206 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4207 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4208 @end deffn
4209
4210 @deffn Command {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4211 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4212
4213 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4214 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4215 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4216 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4217 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4218 for details.
4219
4220 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4221 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4222 the pattern:
4223 @example
4224 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4225 @end example
4226
4227 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4228 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4229 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4230 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4231 @example
4232 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4233 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4234 @end example
4235
4236 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4237 @example
4238 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4239 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4240 @end example
4241
4242 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4243 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4244
4245 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4246 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4247 example with a proper dap name:
4248 @example
4249 xxx.dap apcsw default
4250 @end example
4251 @end deffn
4252
4253 @deffn Command {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4254 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4255 Disabled by default
4256 @end deffn
4257
4258
4259 @node CPU Configuration
4260 @chapter CPU Configuration
4261 @cindex GDB target
4262
4263 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4264 You can also access these targets without GDB
4265 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4266 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4267 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4268 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4269
4270 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4271 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4272
4273 @section Target List
4274 @cindex target, current
4275 @cindex target, list
4276
4277 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4278 where each member has a name.
4279 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4280 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4281 (plural!) command.
4282 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4283 look like with more than one:
4284 @verbatim
4285 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4286 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4287 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4288 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4289 @end verbatim
4290
4291 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4292 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4293 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4294 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4295 space seen by that current target.
4296 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4297 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4298 are examples; and there are many more.
4299
4300 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4301
4302 @deffn Command {target current}
4303 Returns the name of the current target.
4304 @end deffn
4305
4306 @deffn Command {target names}
4307 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4308 @example
4309 foreach t [target names] @{
4310 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4311 @}
4312 @end example
4313 @end deffn
4314
4315 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4316 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4317
4318 @deffn Command targets [name]
4319 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4320 command names are singular.}
4321
4322 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4323 targets in a user friendly form.
4324
4325 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4326 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4327 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4328 @end deffn
4329
4330 @section Target CPU Types
4331 @cindex target type
4332 @cindex CPU type
4333
4334 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4335 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4336 when calling @command{target create}.
4337 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4338 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4339 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4340 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4341 what core-specific commands may be available
4342 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4343 and more.
4344
4345 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4346 since there's a command to list them.
4347
4348 @anchor{targettypes}
4349 @deffn Command {target types}
4350 Lists all supported target types.
4351 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4352
4353 @itemize @bullet
4354 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores
4355 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4356 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4357 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4358 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU
4359 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core
4360 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4361 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4362 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4363 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7 core with an MMU
4364 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7 core, supporting only the
4365 compact Thumb2 instruction set.
4366 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU
4367 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e
4368 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4369 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4370 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4371 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4372 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb)
4373 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926
4374 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of support for new CPUs.
4375 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core
4376 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4377 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4378 @item @code{openrisc} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4379 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4380 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4381 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4382 @itemize @minus
4383 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4384 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4385 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4386 @end itemize
4387 And two debug interfaces cores:
4388 @itemize @minus
4389 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4390 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4391 @end itemize
4392 @end itemize
4393 @end deffn
4394
4395 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4396 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4397 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4398 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4399 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4400 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4401 reflect design generations;
4402 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4403 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4404
4405 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4406 @section Target Configuration
4407
4408 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4409 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4410 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4411 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4412 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4413
4414 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4415 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4416 optional parts.
4417 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4418 command, created as part of target creation.
4419
4420 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4421 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4422 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4423 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4424 to be much more board-specific.
4425 The key steps you use might look something like this
4426
4427 @example
4428 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4429 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4430 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4431 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4432 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4433 @end example
4434
4435 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4436 on-chip SRAM.
4437 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4438 writes to target memory;
4439 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4440 GDB memory checksumming;
4441 and more.
4442
4443 @quotation Warning
4444 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4445 inaccessible when application code
4446 (such as an operating system)
4447 enables or disables the MMU.
4448 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4449 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4450 easy access to other addresses needed.
4451 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4452 @end quotation
4453
4454 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4455 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4456 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4457 controllers.
4458 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4459 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4460 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4461
4462 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4463 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4464 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4465 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4466 purposes including additional configuration.
4467
4468 @itemize @bullet
4469 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4470 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4471 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4472 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4473
4474 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4475 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4476 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4477 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4478 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4479 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4480 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4481
4482 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4483 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4484 @end itemize
4485 @end deffn
4486
4487 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4488 The options accepted by this command may also be
4489 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4490 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4491 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4492
4493 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4494 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4495 and changing its endianness.
4496
4497 @itemize @bullet
4498
4499 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4500 used to access this target.
4501
4502 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4503 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4504 create and manage DAP instances.
4505
4506 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4507 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4508
4509 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4510 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4511 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4512 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4513 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4514 same event name assigns only one handler.
4515
4516 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4517 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4518
4519 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4520 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4521 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4522 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4523 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4524 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4525 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4526
4527 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4528 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4529 or virtual address is being used.
4530
4531 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4532 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4533
4534 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4535 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4536 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4537 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4538 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4539
4540 @anchor{rtostype}
4541 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4542 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4543 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4544 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx}
4545 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4546
4547 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4548 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4549 access the target for debugging.
4550
4551 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4552 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4553 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4554 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4555
4556 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4557 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4558 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4559 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4560 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4561
4562 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4563 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4564 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4565 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4566 command @command{gdb_port}.
4567 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4568 @end itemize
4569 @end deffn
4570
4571 @section Other $target_name Commands
4572 @cindex object command
4573
4574 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4575 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4576
4577 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4578 Once a button is created a button
4579 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4580 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4581 configure it like this:
4582
4583 @example
4584 # Create
4585 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4586 # Modify
4587 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4588 # Query
4589 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4590 # Report
4591 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4592 @end example
4593
4594 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4595 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4596
4597 @example
4598 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4599 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4600 @end example
4601
4602 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4603
4604 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4605 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4606 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4607 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4608 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4609 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4610 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4611 They are not otherwise documented here.
4612 @end deffn
4613
4614 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4615 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4616 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4617 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4618 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4619 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4620 the target side uses raw memory.
4621
4622 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4623 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4624 The script orientation comes from working with data
4625 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4626 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4627 and neither store nor return those values.
4628
4629 @itemize
4630 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4631 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4632 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4633 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4634 @end itemize
4635 @end deffn
4636
4637 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4638 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4639 @command{$target_name configure}
4640 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4641 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4642 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4643 There are a few special cases:
4644
4645 @itemize @bullet
4646 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4647 event named @var{event_name}.
4648 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4649 two parameters.
4650 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4651 This is a special case because this is set using
4652 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4653 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4654 @end itemize
4655
4656 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4657 all the targets you might use something like this:
4658
4659 @example
4660 foreach name [target names] @{
4661 set y [$name cget -endian]
4662 set z [$name cget -type]
4663 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4664 $x $name $y $z]
4665 @}
4666 @end example
4667 @end deffn
4668
4669 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4670 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4671 Displays the current target state:
4672 @code{debug-running},
4673 @code{halted},
4674 @code{reset},
4675 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4676 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4677 @end deffn
4678
4679 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4680 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4681 currently associated with this target.
4682 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4683 @end deffn
4684
4685 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4686 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4687 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4688 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4689 @end deffn
4690
4691 @deffn Command {$target_name mdw} addr [count]
4692 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} addr [count]
4693 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} addr [count]
4694 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4695 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4696 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4697 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4698 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4699 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4700 @end deffn
4701
4702 @deffn Command {$target_name mww} addr word
4703 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} addr halfword
4704 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} addr byte
4705 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4706 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4707 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4708 @end deffn
4709
4710 @anchor{targetevents}
4711 @section Target Events
4712 @cindex target events
4713 @cindex events
4714 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4715 For example:
4716 @itemize @bullet
4717 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4718 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4719 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4720 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4721 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4722 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4723 to set up system clocks or
4724 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4725 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4726 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4727 @end itemize
4728
4729 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4730 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4731 @command{target create ... -event}.
4732
4733 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4734 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4735 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4736
4737 @example
4738 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
4739 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4740 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4741 @}
4742 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
4743 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
4744 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4745 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4746 @}
4747 @end example
4748
4749 The following target events are defined:
4750
4751 @itemize @bullet
4752 @item @b{debug-halted}
4753 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4754 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4755 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
4756 @item @b{early-halted}
4757 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4758 @item @b{examine-start}
4759 @* Before target examine is called.
4760 @item @b{examine-end}
4761 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4762 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4763 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
4764 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
4765 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
4766 connect GDB to running target.
4767 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
4768 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
4769 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
4770 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
4771 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
4772 is in RAM or read only memory.
4773 Default is @code{halt}
4774 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4775 @* When GDB disconnects
4776 @item @b{gdb-end}
4777 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4778 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4779 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4780 @code{reset init})
4781 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4782 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4783 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4784 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4785 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4786 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4787 @item @b{gdb-start}
4788 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
4789 @item @b{halted}
4790 @* The target has halted
4791 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4792 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4793 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
4794 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
4795 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4796 @item @b{reset-assert}
4797 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4798 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4799 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4800 it instead of asserting SRST.
4801 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4802 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4803 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4804 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4805 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4806 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4807 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4808 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4809 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4810 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4811 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4812 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4813 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4814 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4815 released on the scan chain.
4816 @item @b{reset-end}
4817 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4818 @item @b{reset-init}
4819 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4820 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4821
4822 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4823 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4824 multiplexing, and so on.
4825 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4826 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4827 @item @b{reset-start}
4828 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
4829 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
4830
4831 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4832 or @command{adapter_khz} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4833 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4834 @item @b{resume-start}
4835 @* Before any target is resumed
4836 @item @b{resume-end}
4837 @* After all targets have resumed
4838 @item @b{resumed}
4839 @* Target has resumed
4840 @item @b{trace-config}
4841 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
4842 @end itemize
4843
4844 @node Flash Commands
4845 @chapter Flash Commands
4846
4847 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
4848 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
4849 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
4850 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
4851 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
4852 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
4853 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
4854 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
4855 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
4856
4857 Flash Steps:
4858 @enumerate
4859 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
4860 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
4861 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
4862 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
4863 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
4864 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
4865 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
4866 @item GDB Flashing
4867 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
4868 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
4869 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
4870 @end enumerate
4871
4872 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
4873 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
4874 so that it can't boot.
4875 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
4876 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
4877
4878 @anchor{norconfiguration}
4879 @section Flash Configuration Commands
4880 @cindex flash configuration
4881
4882 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
4883 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
4884 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
4885 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
4886 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
4887 see the driver-specific documentation.
4888
4889 @itemize @bullet
4890 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
4891 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
4892 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
4893 associated with the flash bank being declared.
4894 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
4895 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
4896 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
4897 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
4898 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
4899 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
4900 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
4901 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4902 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
4903 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4904 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
4905 commands to the flash controller.
4906 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
4907 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
4908 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
4909 for more information.
4910 @end itemize
4911 @quotation Note
4912 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
4913 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
4914 @end quotation
4915 @end deffn
4916
4917 @comment the REAL name for this command is "ocd_flash_banks"
4918 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
4919 @deffn Command {flash banks}
4920 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
4921 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4922 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
4923 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
4924 @end deffn
4925
4926 @deffn Command {flash list}
4927 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
4928 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4929 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
4930 @end deffn
4931
4932 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
4933 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
4934 depends on the flash type.
4935 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4936 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
4937 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
4938 but most don't bother.
4939 @end deffn
4940
4941 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
4942 @cindex flash erasing
4943 @cindex flash reading
4944 @cindex flash writing
4945 @cindex flash programming
4946 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
4947
4948 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
4949 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
4950 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
4951 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
4952 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
4953
4954 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
4955 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
4956 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
4957 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
4958 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
4959
4960 @quotation Note
4961 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
4962 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
4963 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
4964 back to a flash bank.
4965 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
4966 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
4967 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
4968 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
4969 Avoid confusing the two command models.
4970 @end quotation
4971
4972 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
4973 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
4974 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
4975 disabled first.
4976 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
4977 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
4978 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
4979
4980 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
4981 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4982 up to and including @var{last}.
4983 Sector numbering starts at 0.
4984 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4985 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4986 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4987 @end deffn
4988
4989 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
4990 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
4991 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
4992 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
4993 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
4994 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
4995 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
4996 the specified length must stay within that bank.
4997 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
4998 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
4999 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5000 before erase starts.
5001 @end deffn
5002
5003 @deffn Command {flash fillw} address word length
5004 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
5005 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
5006 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
5007 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5008 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5009 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5010 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5011 before issuing this command.
5012 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5013 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5014 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5015 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5016 @end deffn
5017 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5018
5019 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5020 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5021 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5022 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5023 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5024 @end deffn
5025
5026 @deffn Command {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5027 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5028 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5029 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5030 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5031 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5032 @end deffn
5033
5034 @deffn Command {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5035 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5036 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5037 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5038 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5039 @end deffn
5040
5041 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5042 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5043 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5044 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5045 to the base address for each section in the image.
5046 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5047 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5048 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5049 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5050 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5051 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5052 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5053 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5054 each image section.
5055
5056 @quotation Warning
5057 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5058 data you want to preserve.
5059 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5060 sections might be erased with no notice.
5061 @itemize
5062 @item
5063 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5064 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5065 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5066 @item
5067 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5068 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5069 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5070 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5071 @end itemize
5072 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5073 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5074 @end quotation
5075
5076 @end deffn
5077
5078 @section Other Flash commands
5079 @cindex flash protection
5080
5081 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
5082 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5083 and display that status.
5084 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5085 @end deffn
5086
5087 @deffn Command {flash info} num [sectors]
5088 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5089 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5090
5091 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5092 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5093 and possibly stale information.
5094 @end deffn
5095
5096 @anchor{flashprotect}
5097 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5098 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5099 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5100 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5101 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5102 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5103 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5104 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5105 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5106 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5107 @end deffn
5108
5109 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
5110 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5111 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5112 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5113 @end deffn
5114
5115 @anchor{program}
5116 @deffn Command {program} filename [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5117 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5118 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5119 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5120 @end deffn
5121
5122 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5123 @section Flash Driver List
5124 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5125 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5126 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5127
5128 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
5129 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5130 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5131
5132 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5133
5134 @itemize
5135 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5136 @end itemize
5137
5138 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5139 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5140 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5141 @example
5142 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5143 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5144 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5145 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5146 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5147 @end example
5148 @end deffn
5149
5150 @subsection External Flash
5151
5152 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
5153 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5154 @cindex CFI
5155 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5156 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5157 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5158 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5159 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5160 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5161 configure a bus and its timings), or
5162 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5163 on the flash chip.
5164 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5165 speed up operation.
5166
5167 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5168
5169 @itemize
5170 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5171 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5172 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5173 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5174 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5175 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5176 @end itemize
5177
5178 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5179 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5180
5181 @example
5182 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5183 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5184 @end example
5185
5186 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5187 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5188 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5189
5190 @example
5191 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5192 @end example
5193
5194 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5195 @end deffn
5196
5197 @deffn {Flash Driver} jtagspi
5198 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5199 @cindex SPI
5200 @cindex jtagspi
5201 @cindex bscan_spi
5202 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5203 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5204 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5205 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5206 accessed through JTAG.
5207
5208 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5209 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5210 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5211 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5212 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5213 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5214
5215 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5216 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5217 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5218 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5219 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5220 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5221 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5222 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5223
5224 @itemize
5225 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5226 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5227 @var{USER1} instruction.
5228 @end itemize
5229
5230 @example
5231 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5232 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5233 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5234 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5235 @end example
5236 @end deffn
5237
5238 @deffn {Flash Driver} xcf
5239 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5240 @cindex xcf
5241 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5242 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5243 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5244 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5245 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5246
5247 @deffn Command {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5248 command accepts additional parameters:
5249 @itemize
5250 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5251 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5252 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5253 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5254 in master mode.
5255 @end itemize
5256 @example
5257 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5258 @end example
5259 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5260 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5261 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5262 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5263 dedicated sector.
5264 @end deffn
5265
5266 @deffn Command {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5267 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5268 button.
5269 @example
5270 xcf configure 0
5271 @end example
5272 @end deffn
5273
5274 Additional driver notes:
5275 @itemize
5276 @item Only single revision supported.
5277 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5278 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5279 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5280 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5281 @end itemize
5282 @end deffn
5283
5284 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
5285 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5286 @cindex SPIFI
5287 @cindex lpcspifi
5288 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5289 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5290 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5291
5292 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5293 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5294 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5295 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5296 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5297
5298 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5299 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5300 are configured by the driver.
5301
5302 @example
5303 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5304 @end example
5305
5306 @end deffn
5307
5308 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
5309 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5310 @cindex SMI
5311 @cindex stmsmi
5312 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5313 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5314 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5315 SPI flash devices.
5316 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5317 flash devices can be connected.
5318
5319 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5320 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5321 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5322 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5323 the flash content.
5324
5325 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5326 to identify the memory bank.
5327 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5328 flash size, are detected automatically.
5329
5330 @example
5331 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5332 @end example
5333
5334 @end deffn
5335
5336 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
5337 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5338 Microcontroller platform.
5339
5340 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5341 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5342
5343 @example
5344 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5345 @end example
5346
5347 @end deffn
5348
5349 @deffn {Flash Driver} ath79
5350 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5351 @cindex ath79
5352 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5353 chip selects.
5354 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5355 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5356 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5357 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5358 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5359 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5360
5361 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5362 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5363 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5364 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5365 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5366 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5367 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5368 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5369 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5370 with the default CS0.
5371 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5372 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5373 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5374
5375 @example
5376 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5377
5378 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different for each,
5379 # otherwise the write_image command is not able to distinguish the
5380 # banks.
5381 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5382 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5383 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5384 @end example
5385
5386 @end deffn
5387
5388 @deffn {Flash Driver} fespi
5389 @cindex Freedom E SPI
5390 @cindex fespi
5391
5392 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
5393
5394 @example
5395 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5396 @end example
5397 @end deffn
5398
5399 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5400
5401 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
5402 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5403 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5404 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5405 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5406 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5407
5408 @example
5409 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5410 @end example
5411 @end deffn
5412
5413 @deffn {Flash Driver} ambiqmicro
5414 @cindex ambiqmicro
5415 @cindex apollo
5416 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5417 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5418 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5419 with the target using SWD.
5420
5421 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5422 the device class of the MCU.
5423 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5424 to set up the flash banks.
5425 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5426 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5427
5428 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5429 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5430 and the second bank starts after the first.
5431
5432 @example
5433 # Flash bank 0
5434 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5435 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5436 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5437 $_TARGETNAME
5438 @end example
5439
5440 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5441 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5442 are available to the user.
5443
5444 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5445
5446 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5447 Erase entire bank.
5448 @end deffn
5449 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5450 Erase device pages.
5451 @end deffn
5452 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5453 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5454 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5455 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5456 the flash.
5457 @end deffn
5458 @end deffn
5459
5460 @anchor{at91samd}
5461 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
5462 @cindex at91samd
5463 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5464 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5465
5466 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
5467
5468 The devices have one flash bank:
5469
5470 @example
5471 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5472 @end example
5473
5474 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
5475 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5476 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5477 processor to be halted.
5478 @end deffn
5479
5480 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
5481 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5482 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5483 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5484 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5485 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5486
5487 @example
5488 at91samd set-security enable
5489 @end example
5490 @end deffn
5491
5492 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
5493 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5494 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5495 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5496 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5497 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
5498 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5499 in order to disable this feature.
5500
5501 @example
5502 at91samd eeprom
5503 at91samd eeprom 1024
5504 @end example
5505 @end deffn
5506
5507 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
5508 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5509 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5510 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5511 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5512 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5513
5514 @example
5515 at91samd bootloader
5516 at91samd bootloader 16384
5517 @end example
5518 @end deffn
5519
5520 @deffn Command {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5521 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5522 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5523 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5524 @end deffn
5525
5526 @deffn Command {at91samd nvmuserrow}
5527 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
5528 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
5529 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
5530 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5531 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
5532 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
5533 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
5534
5535 @example
5536 # Read user row
5537 >at91samd nvmuserrow
5538 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5539 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
5540 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5541 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low byte unchanged
5542 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
5543 @end example
5544 @end deffn
5545
5546 @end deffn
5547
5548 @anchor{at91sam3}
5549 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
5550 @cindex at91sam3
5551 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5552 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5553 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5554 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5555 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5556 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5557 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
5558 chips are confirmed.}
5559
5560 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5561 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5562 the following fixed locations:
5563
5564 @example
5565 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5566 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5567 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5568 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5569 @end example
5570
5571 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5572 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5573 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5574
5575 @itemize
5576 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5577 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5578 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5579 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5580 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5581 @end itemize
5582
5583 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5584
5585 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5586 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5587 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5588 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5589 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5590 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5591 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5592
5593 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5594 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5595 @end deffn
5596
5597 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
5598 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5599 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5600 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5601 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5602 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5603 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5604 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5605 @end deffn
5606
5607 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5608 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5609 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5610 @end deffn
5611 @end deffn
5612
5613 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5614 @cindex at91sam4
5615 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5616 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5617 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5618 @end deffn
5619
5620 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
5621 @cindex at91sam4l
5622 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
5623 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5624 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5625
5626 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
5627 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
5628 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
5629 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5630 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5631 @end deffn
5632 @end deffn
5633
5634 @anchor{atsame5}
5635 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsame5
5636 @cindex atsame5
5637 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
5638 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
5639 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5640
5641 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
5642 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
5643 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
5644
5645 @example
5646 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5647 @end example
5648
5649 @deffn Command {atsame5 bootloader}
5650 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
5651 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5652 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
5653 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
5654 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5655
5656 @example
5657 atsame5 bootloader
5658 atsame5 bootloader 16384
5659 @end example
5660 @end deffn
5661
5662 @deffn Command {atsame5 chip-erase}
5663 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5664 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5665 processor to be halted.
5666 @end deffn
5667
5668 @deffn Command {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
5669 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5670 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5671 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5672 @end deffn
5673
5674 @deffn Command {atsame5 userpage}
5675 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
5676 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
5677 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
5678 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5679 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
5680 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
5681 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
5682
5683 @example
5684 # Read
5685 >atsame5 userpage
5686 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
5687 # Write
5688 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
5689 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other bits unchanged
5690 # (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192 bytes)
5691 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
5692 @end example
5693 @end deffn
5694
5695 @end deffn
5696
5697 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsamv
5698 @cindex atsamv
5699 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
5700 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
5701 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5702 @end deffn
5703
5704 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
5705 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
5706 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
5707 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
5708 register, and autoconfigures itself.
5709
5710 @example
5711 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5712 @end example
5713
5714 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
5715 provide additional parameters in the following order:
5716
5717 @itemize
5718 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
5719 @item @var{banks}
5720 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
5721 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
5722 @item @var{pages_size}
5723 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
5724 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
5725 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
5726 @end itemize
5727
5728 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
5729 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
5730 will be autoconfigured.
5731 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
5732
5733 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
5734 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
5735 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
5736 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
5737 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
5738
5739 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
5740 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
5741 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
5742 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
5743 are not truly general purpose).
5744 @quotation Note
5745 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
5746 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
5747 @end quotation
5748 @end deffn
5749 @end deffn
5750
5751 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
5752 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
5753 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
5754 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5755 @end deffn
5756
5757 @deffn {Flash Driver} bluenrg-x
5758 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1 and BlueNRG-2 Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0 core and internal flash memory.
5759 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
5760 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
5761
5762 @example
5763 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5764 @end example
5765
5766 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
5767 each single sector one by one.
5768
5769 @example
5770 flash erase_sector 0 0 79 # It will perform a mass erase on BlueNRG-1
5771 @end example
5772
5773 @example
5774 flash erase_sector 0 0 127 # It will perform a mass erase on BlueNRG-2
5775 @end example
5776
5777 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
5778 @end deffn
5779
5780 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc26xx
5781 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
5782 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
5783 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
5784 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
5785 starts at address 0.
5786
5787 @example
5788 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5789 @end example
5790 @end deffn
5791
5792 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc3220sf
5793 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
5794 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
5795 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
5796 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
5797 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
5798 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
5799 and programming the serial flash.
5800
5801 @example
5802 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5803 @end example
5804 @end deffn
5805
5806 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
5807 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
5808 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
5809 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
5810 autoconfigures itself.
5811 @example
5812 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5813 @end example
5814 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
5815 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
5816 this via the following command:
5817 @example
5818 efm32 debuglock num
5819 @end example
5820 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5821 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
5822 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
5823 supported.}
5824 @end deffn
5825
5826 @deffn {Flash Driver} esirisc
5827 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
5828 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
5829 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
5830 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
5831 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
5832
5833 @example
5834 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
5835 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
5836 @end example
5837
5838 @deffn Command {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
5839 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
5840 @end deffn
5841
5842 @deffn Command {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
5843 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
5844 is an uncommon operation.}
5845 @end deffn
5846 @end deffn
5847
5848 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
5849 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
5850 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
5851 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
5852 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5853 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
5854 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
5855
5856 @example
5857 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5858 @end example
5859 @end deffn
5860
5861 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm4
5862 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
5863 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
5864 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
5865 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5866 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
5867 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
5868 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
5869 characters) ignored.
5870
5871 @example
5872 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
5873 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5874 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
5875 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5876 @end example
5877 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
5878 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
5879 @end deffn
5880
5881 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis
5882 @cindex kinetis
5883 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
5884 from NXP (former Freescale) include
5885 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
5886 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
5887 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5888 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
5889
5890 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
5891 @itemize
5892 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
5893 @end itemize
5894
5895 @example
5896 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5897 @end example
5898
5899 @deffn Command {kinetis create_banks}
5900 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
5901 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
5902 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
5903 @end deffn
5904
5905 @deffn Command {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
5906 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
5907 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
5908 set by 'flash protect' command.
5909 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
5910 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
5911 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
5912 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
5913 with the rest of a flash image.
5914 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
5915 @end deffn
5916
5917 @deffn Command {kinetis fopt} [num]
5918 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
5919 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
5920 @end deffn
5921
5922 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm check_security}
5923 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5924 @end deffn
5925
5926 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm halt}
5927 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
5928 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
5929 @end deffn
5930
5931 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
5932 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
5933 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
5934 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
5935 command completes.
5936 @end deffn
5937
5938 @deffn Command {kinetis nvm_partition}
5939 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
5940 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
5941 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
5942 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
5943
5944 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
5945 Program Partition command.
5946
5947 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
5948 Reset the device after partition setting.
5949
5950 Show partition size:
5951 @example
5952 kinetis nvm_partition info
5953 @end example
5954
5955 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
5956 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
5957 @example
5958 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
5959 @end example
5960
5961 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
5962 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
5963 @example
5964 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
5965 @end example
5966 @end deffn
5967
5968 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm reset}
5969 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
5970 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
5971 @end deffn
5972
5973 @deffn Command {kinetis disable_wdog}
5974 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
5975 Command disables watchdog timer.
5976 @end deffn
5977 @end deffn
5978
5979 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis_ke
5980 @cindex kinetis_ke
5981 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
5982 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
5983 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
5984 autoconfigures itself.
5985 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
5986
5987 @example
5988 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5989 @end example
5990
5991 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
5992 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5993 @end deffn
5994
5995 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
5996 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
5997 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
5998 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
5999 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6000 @end deffn
6001
6002 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6003 Command disables watchdog timer.
6004 @end deffn
6005 @end deffn
6006
6007 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
6008 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6009 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6010 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6011 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6012
6013 @quotation Note
6014 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6015 driver:
6016 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6017 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6018 @end quotation
6019
6020 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6021 which must appear in the following order:
6022
6023 @itemize
6024 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6025 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6026 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6027 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6028 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6029 LPC43x[2357])
6030 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6031 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6032 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6033 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6034 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6035 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6036 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6037 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6038 at which the core is running
6039 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6040 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6041 @quotation Note
6042 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6043 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6044 However, if you do provide it,
6045 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6046 @end quotation
6047 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6048 ROM IAP entry point.
6049 @end itemize
6050
6051 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6052
6053 @example
6054 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6055 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6056 @end example
6057
6058 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6059 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6060 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6061 @end deffn
6062 @end deffn
6063
6064 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
6065 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6066 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6067 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6068 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6069 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6070
6071 @example
6072 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6073 @end example
6074 @end deffn
6075
6076 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
6077 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6078 from NXP.
6079
6080 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6081 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6082 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6083 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6084 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6085 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6086 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6087 you start the PLL.
6088
6089 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6090
6091 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6092 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6093 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6094
6095 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6096 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6097 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6098 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6099 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6100 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6101 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6102
6103 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6104 @example
6105 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6106 @end example
6107
6108 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6109 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6110 @code{flash banks} command.
6111
6112 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
6113 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6114 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6115 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6116 a known signature.
6117 Example:
6118 @example
6119 lpc2900 signature 0
6120 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6121 @end example
6122 @end deffn
6123
6124 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6125 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6126 saves it to a file in binary format.
6127 Example:
6128 @example
6129 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6130 @end example
6131 @end deffn
6132
6133 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6134 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6135 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6136 command:
6137
6138 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
6139 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6140 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6141 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6142
6143 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6144 Example:
6145 @example
6146 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6147 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6148 @end example
6149 @end deffn
6150
6151 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6152 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6153 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6154 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6155 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6156 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6157 912 bytes.
6158 @quotation Attention
6159 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6160 @end quotation
6161 Example:
6162 @example
6163 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6164 @end example
6165 @end deffn
6166
6167 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6168 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6169 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6170 after the next power cycle.
6171 @quotation Attention
6172 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6173 @end quotation
6174 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6175 Example:
6176 @example
6177 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6178 flash info 0
6179 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6180 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6181 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6182 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6183 @end example
6184 @end deffn
6185
6186 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6187 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6188 effective after the next power cycle.
6189 @quotation Attention
6190 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6191 @end quotation
6192 Examples:
6193 @example
6194 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6195 @end example
6196 @end deffn
6197 @end deffn
6198
6199 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
6200 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6201 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6202 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6203
6204 @example
6205 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6206 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6207 @end example
6208
6209 @itemize @bullet
6210 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6211 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6212 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6213 @end itemize
6214
6215 Example usage:
6216 @example
6217 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6218 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6219 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6220 @} else @{
6221 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6222 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6223 @}
6224 @end example
6225 @end deffn
6226
6227 @deffn {Flash Driver} msp432
6228 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6229 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6230 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6231 Main program flash (starting at address 0) is flash bank 0. Information flash
6232 region on MSP432P4 versions (starting at address 0x200000) is flash bank 1.
6233
6234 @example
6235 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6236 @end example
6237
6238 @deffn Command {msp432 mass_erase} [main|all]
6239 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6240 only the main program flash.
6241
6242 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6243 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6244 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6245 @end deffn
6246
6247 @deffn Command {msp432 bsl} [unlock|lock]
6248 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6249 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6250 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6251
6252 To erase and program the BSL:
6253 @example
6254 msp432 bsl unlock
6255 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6256 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6257 msp432 bsl lock
6258 @end example
6259 @end deffn
6260 @end deffn
6261
6262 @deffn {Flash Driver} niietcm4
6263 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6264 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6265 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6266 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6267 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6268 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6269 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6270 also have division into regions: main and info.
6271 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6272 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6273
6274 @example
6275 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6276 @end example
6277
6278 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6279
6280 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6281 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6282 @end deffn
6283
6284 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6285 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6286 @end deffn
6287
6288 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6289 Erase all userflash including info region.
6290 @end deffn
6291
6292 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6293 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6294 @end deffn
6295
6296 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6297 Check sectors protect.
6298 @end deffn
6299
6300 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6301 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6302 @end deffn
6303
6304 @deffn Command {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6305 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6306 @end deffn
6307
6308 @deffn Command {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6309 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6310 @end deffn
6311
6312 @deffn Command {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6313 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6314 @end deffn
6315
6316 @deffn Command {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6317 Show information about flash driver.
6318 @end deffn
6319
6320 @end deffn
6321
6322 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf5
6323 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6324 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
6325 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
6326 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
6327
6328 @example
6329 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6330 @end example
6331
6332 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6333
6334 @deffn Command {nrf5 mass_erase}
6335 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6336 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6337 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6338 code.
6339 @end deffn
6340
6341 @end deffn
6342
6343 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
6344 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6345 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6346
6347 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6348 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6349 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6350 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6351
6352 @example
6353 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6354 @end example
6355 @end deffn
6356
6357 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
6358 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6359 and integrate flash memory.
6360
6361 @example
6362 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6363 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6364 @end example
6365
6366 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6367 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6368 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6369 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6370 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6371 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6372 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6373 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6374 @end deffn
6375 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
6376 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6377 This will remove any Code Protection.
6378 @end deffn
6379 @end deffn
6380
6381 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
6382 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6383 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6384 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6385 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6386
6387 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6388 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6389
6390 @example
6391 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6392 @end example
6393
6394 psoc4-specific commands
6395 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6396 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6397
6398 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6399 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6400
6401 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6402 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6403 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6404
6405 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6406 @end deffn
6407
6408 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6409 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6410
6411 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6412 @end deffn
6413 @end deffn
6414
6415 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp
6416 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6417 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6418 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6419 apart from the base address.
6420
6421 @example
6422 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6423 @end example
6424
6425 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6426 @quotation Attention
6427 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6428 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6429 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6430 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6431 @end quotation
6432
6433 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6434
6435 @deffn Command {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6436 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6437 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6438 @end deffn
6439 @end deffn
6440
6441 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_eeprom
6442 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6443 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6444 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6445 apart from the base address.
6446
6447 @example
6448 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6449 @end example
6450 @end deffn
6451
6452 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_nvl
6453 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6454 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6455 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
6456
6457 @example
6458 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6459 @end example
6460
6461 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
6462
6463 @itemize
6464 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
6465 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
6466 @end itemize
6467
6468 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
6469
6470 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
6471 @quotation Attention
6472 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
6473 after successful write.
6474 @end quotation
6475 @end deffn
6476
6477 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc6
6478 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
6479 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
6480 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
6481
6482 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
6483 @itemize @bullet
6484 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
6485 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
6486 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
6487 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
6488 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
6489 row size: 512 bytes.
6490 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
6491 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
6492 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
6493 operation will erase row automatically.
6494 @end itemize
6495
6496 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
6497 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
6498
6499 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
6500
6501 @example
6502 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6503 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6504 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6505 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6506 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6507 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6508
6509 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6510 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6511 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6512 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6513 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6514 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6515 @end example
6516
6517 psoc6-specific commands
6518 @deffn Command {psoc6 reset_halt}
6519 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
6520 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
6521 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
6522 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
6523 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
6524 @end deffn
6525
6526 @deffn Command {psoc6 mass_erase} num
6527 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
6528 by @command{flash banks}.
6529 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
6530 @end deffn
6531 @end deffn
6532
6533 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
6534 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
6535 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
6536 and SWD interface.
6537 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
6538 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
6539
6540 @example
6541 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6542 @end example
6543
6544 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
6545
6546 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
6547 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
6548 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
6549 @end deffn
6550
6551 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
6552 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
6553 @end deffn
6554 @end deffn
6555
6556 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
6557 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
6558 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
6559 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
6560 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6561
6562 @example
6563 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6564 @end example
6565
6566 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
6567 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
6568 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
6569 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
6570 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
6571 disabled.
6572
6573 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
6574 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
6575 @quotation Warning
6576 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
6577 applied to all of them.
6578 @end quotation
6579 @end deffn
6580 @end deffn
6581
6582 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
6583 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
6584 from STMicroelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
6585 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6586 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6587
6588 @example
6589 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6590 @end example
6591
6592 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6593 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6594 the flash driver.
6595
6596 @example
6597 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6598 @end example
6599
6600 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
6601 as per the following example.
6602 @example
6603 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6604 @end example
6605
6606 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
6607
6608 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
6609 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
6610 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6611 @end deffn
6612
6613 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
6614 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
6615 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
6616 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6617 @end deffn
6618
6619 @deffn Command {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
6620 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
6621 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6622 @end deffn
6623
6624 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
6625 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
6626 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
6627 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6628 @end deffn
6629
6630 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
6631 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
6632 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6633 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
6634 @end deffn
6635
6636 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_load} num
6637 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
6638 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
6639 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
6640 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6641 @end deffn
6642 @end deffn
6643
6644 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
6645 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6646 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
6647 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6648 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6649
6650 @example
6651 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6652 @end example
6653
6654 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
6655 as per the following example.
6656 @example
6657 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6658 @end example
6659
6660 @deffn Command {stm32f2x otp } num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
6661 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
6662 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6663 @end deffn
6664
6665 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6666 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6667 the flash driver.
6668
6669 @example
6670 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6671 @end example
6672
6673 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
6674
6675 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
6676 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6677 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6678 @end deffn
6679
6680 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
6681 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6682 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6683 @end deffn
6684
6685 @deffn Command {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
6686 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
6687 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6688 @end deffn
6689
6690 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_read} num
6691 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
6692 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6693 @end deffn
6694
6695 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
6696 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
6697 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
6698 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
6699 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
6700 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
6701 @end deffn
6702
6703 @deffn Command {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
6704 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
6705 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
6706 @end deffn
6707 @end deffn
6708
6709 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32h7x
6710 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6711 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
6712 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6713 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6714
6715 @example
6716 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6717 @end example
6718
6719 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6720 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6721 the flash driver.
6722
6723 @example
6724 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6725 @end example
6726
6727 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
6728
6729 @deffn Command {stm32h7x lock} num
6730 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6731 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6732 @end deffn
6733
6734 @deffn Command {stm32h7x unlock} num
6735 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6736 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6737 @end deffn
6738
6739 @deffn Command {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
6740 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
6741 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6742 @end deffn
6743 @end deffn
6744
6745 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
6746 All members of the STM32L microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6747 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
6748 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6749 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6750
6751 @example
6752 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6753 @end example
6754
6755 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6756 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6757 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
6758 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
6759 second bank.
6760
6761 @example
6762 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6763 @end example
6764
6765 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
6766
6767 @deffn Command {stm32lx lock} num
6768 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6769 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6770 @end deffn
6771
6772 @deffn Command {stm32lx unlock} num
6773 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6774 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6775 @end deffn
6776
6777 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
6778 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
6779 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
6780 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
6781 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6782 @end deffn
6783 @end deffn
6784
6785 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32l4x
6786 All members of the STM32L4 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6787 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6788 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6789 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6790
6791 @example
6792 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6793 @end example
6794
6795 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6796 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6797 the flash driver.
6798
6799 @example
6800 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6801 @end example
6802
6803 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
6804
6805 @deffn Command {stm32l4x lock} num
6806 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6807 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6808 @end deffn
6809
6810 @deffn Command {stm32l4x unlock} num
6811 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6812 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6813 @end deffn
6814
6815 @deffn Command {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
6816 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
6817 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6818 @end deffn
6819
6820 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
6821 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
6822 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6823 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
6824
6825 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
6826 @example
6827 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
6828 # Option Register: <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
6829 @end example
6830
6831 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
6832 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
6833 @end deffn
6834
6835 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
6836 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
6837 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6838 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
6839 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
6840
6841 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
6842 @example
6843 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
6844 @end example
6845
6846 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
6847 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
6848 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
6849 @end deffn
6850
6851 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_load} num
6852 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a reset of the device.
6853 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6854 @end deffn
6855 @end deffn
6856
6857 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
6858 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
6859 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6860 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
6861 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
6862
6863 @example
6864 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
6865 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
6866 @end example
6867
6868 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
6869 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
6870 for the specified flash bank.
6871 @end deffn
6872 @end deffn
6873
6874 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
6875 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
6876 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
6877 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
6878 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
6879
6880 @example
6881 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6882 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
6883 @end example
6884
6885 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
6886 Configures the str9 flash controller.
6887 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6888
6889 @itemize @bullet
6890 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
6891 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
6892 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
6893 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
6894 @end itemize
6895 @end deffn
6896
6897 @end deffn
6898
6899 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
6900 @cindex str9xpec
6901
6902 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
6903 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
6904 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
6905 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
6906
6907 Here is some background info to help
6908 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
6909 the str9:
6910 @enumerate
6911 @item
6912 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
6913 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
6914 @item
6915 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
6916 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
6917 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
6918 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
6919 @end enumerate
6920
6921 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
6922 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
6923 configured for flash bank 0.
6924 @example
6925 # assert srst, we do not want core running
6926 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
6927 jtag_reset 0 1
6928 # turn off target polling
6929 poll off
6930 # disable str9 core
6931 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
6932 # read option bytes
6933 str9xpec options_read 0
6934 # re-enable str9 core
6935 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
6936 poll on
6937 reset halt
6938 @end example
6939 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
6940 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
6941 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
6942 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
6943
6944 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
6945
6946 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
6947 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
6948 @end deffn
6949
6950 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
6951 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
6952 directly to the embedded flash controller.
6953 @end deffn
6954
6955 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
6956 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
6957 erase the device.
6958 @end deffn
6959
6960 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
6961 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
6962 @end deffn
6963
6964 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
6965 Configure str9 boot bank.
6966 @end deffn
6967
6968 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
6969 Configure str9 lvd source.
6970 @end deffn
6971
6972 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
6973 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
6974 @end deffn
6975
6976 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
6977 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
6978 @end deffn
6979
6980 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
6981 Read str9 option bytes.
6982 @end deffn
6983
6984 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
6985 Write str9 option bytes.
6986 @end deffn
6987
6988 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
6989 unlock str9 device.
6990 @end deffn
6991
6992 @end deffn
6993
6994 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
6995 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
6996 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6997 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6998
6999 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
7000
7001 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
7002 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
7003 @end deffn
7004
7005 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
7006 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
7007 @end deffn
7008
7009 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
7010 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
7011 the flash clock.
7012 @end deffn
7013 @end deffn
7014
7015 @deffn {Flash Driver} w600
7016 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
7017 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
7018 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
7019 correct bank config.
7020
7021 @example
7022 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
7023 @end example
7024 @end deffn
7025
7026 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc1xxx
7027 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7028 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7029 @end deffn
7030
7031 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc4xxx
7032 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7033 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7034
7035 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
7036
7037 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
7038 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
7039 @end deffn
7040
7041 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
7042 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
7043 @end deffn
7044
7045 @end deffn
7046
7047 @section NAND Flash Commands
7048 @cindex NAND
7049
7050 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
7051 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
7052 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
7053
7054 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
7055 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
7056 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
7057 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
7058 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
7059 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
7060
7061 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
7062 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
7063 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
7064 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
7065 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
7066 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
7067 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
7068 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
7069 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
7070 with techniques such as wear leveling.
7071
7072 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
7073 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
7074 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
7075 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
7076 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
7077 every 512 bytes of data.
7078
7079 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
7080 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
7081 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
7082 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
7083 ECC mode is used.
7084
7085 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
7086 @enumerate
7087 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
7088 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
7089 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
7090 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
7091 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
7092 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
7093 to access that device.
7094 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
7095 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
7096 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
7097 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
7098 de-brick a board.
7099 @end enumerate
7100
7101 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
7102 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
7103 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
7104 are only 32 bits wide.
7105 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
7106 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
7107 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
7108 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
7109
7110 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
7111 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
7112 @cindex NAND configuration
7113
7114 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
7115 plus some additional configuration that's done after
7116 OpenOCD has initialized.
7117
7118 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
7119 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
7120 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
7121 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
7122 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
7123 they were a single (larger) device.
7124 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
7125 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
7126
7127 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
7128 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
7129 configuration files, not interactively.
7130
7131 @itemize @bullet
7132 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7133 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7134 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7135 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7136 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7137 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7138 commands to the NAND controller.
7139 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7140 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7141 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7142 for more information.
7143 @end itemize
7144 @end deffn
7145
7146 @deffn Command {nand list}
7147 Prints a summary of each device declared
7148 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7149 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7150 @example
7151 > nand list
7152 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7153 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7154 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7155 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7156 >
7157 @end example
7158 @end deffn
7159
7160 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
7161 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7162 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7163 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7164 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7165 it with most other NAND commands.
7166 @end deffn
7167
7168 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7169
7170 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7171 @cindex NAND reading
7172 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7173 starting at the specified offset.
7174 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7175
7176 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7177 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7178
7179 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7180 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7181 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7182
7183 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7184 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7185 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7186 method which handled that error correction.
7187
7188 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7189 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7190 @itemize @bullet
7191 @item no oob_* parameter
7192 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7193 @item @code{oob_raw}
7194 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7195 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7196 spare areas associated with each data page.
7197 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7198 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7199 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7200 @item @code{oob_only}
7201 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7202 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7203 spare areas associated with each data page.
7204 @end itemize
7205 @end deffn
7206
7207 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
7208 @cindex NAND erasing
7209 @cindex NAND programming
7210 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7211 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7212 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7213 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7214 If those parameters are not specified,
7215 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7216 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7217
7218 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7219 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7220 block marker.
7221 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7222 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7223 @end deffn
7224
7225 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7226 @cindex NAND writing
7227 @cindex NAND programming
7228 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7229 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7230 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7231 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7232
7233 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7234 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7235
7236 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7237 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7238 past the end of the device.
7239 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7240 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7241 if that's being written.)
7242
7243 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7244 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7245 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7246
7247 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7248 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7249 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7250 @itemize @bullet
7251 @item no oob_* parameter
7252 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7253 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7254 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7255 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7256 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7257 @item @code{oob_only}
7258 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7259 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7260 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7261 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7262 @item @code{oob_raw}
7263 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7264 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7265 un-altered OOB.
7266 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7267 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7268 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7269 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7270 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7271 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7272 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7273 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7274 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7275 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7276 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7277 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7278 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7279 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7280 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7281 @end itemize
7282 @end deffn
7283
7284 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7285 @cindex NAND verification
7286 @cindex NAND programming
7287 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7288 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7289 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7290
7291 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7292 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7293
7294 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7295 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7296 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7297 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7298 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7299
7300 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7301 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7302 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7303
7304 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7305 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7306 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7307 be removed in a future release.
7308 @end deffn
7309
7310 @subsection Other NAND commands
7311 @cindex NAND other commands
7312
7313 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7314 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7315 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7316 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7317 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7318 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7319 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7320 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7321
7322 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7323 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7324 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7325 @end deffn
7326
7327 @deffn Command {nand info} num
7328 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7329 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
7330 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
7331 status for each block.
7332 @end deffn
7333
7334 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7335 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
7336 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7337
7338 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
7339 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
7340 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
7341 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
7342 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
7343
7344 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
7345 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
7346 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
7347 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
7348 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
7349 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
7350 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
7351 @end deffn
7352
7353 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
7354 @subsection NAND Driver List
7355 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
7356 driver-specific options and behaviors.
7357 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
7358
7359 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
7360 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
7361 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
7362 address of the ECC controller.
7363 @example
7364 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
7365 @end example
7366 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
7367 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
7368 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
7369 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
7370 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
7371 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
7372 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
7373 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7374 @end deffn
7375 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
7376 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
7377 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7378 @end deffn
7379
7380 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
7381 properly configured for input or output.
7382 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
7383 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
7384 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7385 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7386 @end deffn
7387 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
7388 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
7389 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7390 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7391 @end deffn
7392 @end deffn
7393
7394 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
7395 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
7396 chips from Texas Instruments.
7397 It takes three extra parameters:
7398 address of the NAND chip;
7399 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
7400 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
7401 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
7402 @example
7403 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
7404 @end example
7405 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
7406 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
7407 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
7408 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
7409 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
7410 @end deffn
7411
7412 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
7413 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7414 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
7415 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
7416 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
7417 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
7418 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7419 @end deffn
7420
7421 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
7422 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
7423 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
7424 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
7425 @end deffn
7426 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
7427
7428 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
7429 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
7430 should work for this chip as well.
7431 @end deffn
7432
7433 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
7434 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
7435 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
7436 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
7437 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
7438 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
7439 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
7440 @example
7441 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
7442 @end example
7443 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
7444 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
7445 without parameter query status.
7446 @end deffn
7447 @end deffn
7448
7449 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
7450 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7451 parameter: the address of the controller.
7452 @example
7453 nand device orion 0xd8000000
7454 @end example
7455 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
7456 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7457 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7458 change any behavior.
7459 @end deffn
7460
7461 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
7462 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
7463 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
7464 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
7465 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
7466 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
7467 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
7468 specialized commands.
7469 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7470 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7471 change any behavior.
7472 @end deffn
7473
7474 @section mFlash
7475
7476 @subsection mFlash Configuration
7477 @cindex mFlash Configuration
7478
7479 @deffn {Config Command} {mflash bank} soc base RST_pin target
7480 Configures a mflash for @var{soc} host bank at
7481 address @var{base}.
7482 The pin number format depends on the host GPIO naming convention.
7483 Currently, the mflash driver supports s3c2440 and pxa270.
7484
7485 Example for s3c2440 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO B1:
7486
7487 @example
7488 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME s3c2440 0x10000000 1b 0
7489 @end example
7490
7491 Example for pxa270 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO 43:
7492
7493 @example
7494 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME pxa270 0x08000000 43 0
7495 @end example
7496 @end deffn
7497
7498 @subsection mFlash commands
7499 @cindex mFlash commands
7500
7501 @deffn Command {mflash config pll} frequency
7502 Configure mflash PLL.
7503 The @var{frequency} is the mflash input frequency, in Hz.
7504 Issuing this command will erase mflash's whole internal nand and write new pll.
7505 After this command, mflash needs power-on-reset for normal operation.
7506 If pll was newly configured, storage and boot(optional) info also need to be update.
7507 @end deffn
7508
7509 @deffn Command {mflash config boot}
7510 Configure bootable option.
7511 If bootable option is set, mflash offer the first 8 sectors
7512 (4kB) for boot.
7513 @end deffn
7514
7515 @deffn Command {mflash config storage}
7516 Configure storage information.
7517 For the normal storage operation, this information must be
7518 written.
7519 @end deffn
7520
7521 @deffn Command {mflash dump} num filename offset size
7522 Dump @var{size} bytes, starting at @var{offset} bytes from the
7523 beginning of the bank @var{num}, to the file named @var{filename}.
7524 @end deffn
7525
7526 @deffn Command {mflash probe}
7527 Probe mflash.
7528 @end deffn
7529
7530 @deffn Command {mflash write} num filename offset
7531 Write the binary file @var{filename} to mflash bank @var{num}, starting at
7532 @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
7533 @end deffn
7534
7535 @node Flash Programming
7536 @chapter Flash Programming
7537
7538 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
7539 Programming can be achieved by either using GDB @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
7540 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
7541
7542 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
7543 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
7544
7545 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
7546 @enumerate
7547 @item 'init' is executed.
7548 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
7549 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
7550 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
7551 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
7552 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
7553 @end enumerate
7554
7555 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
7556
7557 @example
7558 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
7559 # are optional parameters
7560 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7561 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
7562
7563 # binary files need the flash address passing
7564 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7565 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
7566 @end example
7567
7568 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
7569 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
7570 @cindex PLD
7571 @cindex FPGA
7572
7573 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
7574 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
7575 OpenOCD can support programming them.
7576 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
7577 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
7578 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
7579 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
7580
7581 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
7582
7583 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
7584 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
7585 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
7586
7587 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
7588 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
7589
7590 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
7591 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
7592 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
7593 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
7594 behavior.
7595 @end deffn
7596
7597 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
7598 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
7599 @end deffn
7600
7601 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
7602 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
7603 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
7604 @end deffn
7605
7606 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
7607
7608 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
7609 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
7610 that particular type of PLD.
7611
7612 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
7613 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
7614 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
7615
7616 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
7617 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
7618 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
7619
7620 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
7621 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
7622 for FPGA @var{num}.
7623 @end deffn
7624 @end deffn
7625
7626 @node General Commands
7627 @chapter General Commands
7628 @cindex commands
7629
7630 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
7631 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
7632 commands are documented elsewhere.
7633
7634 Intent:
7635 @itemize @bullet
7636 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
7637 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
7638 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
7639 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
7640
7641 @item @b{From the human}
7642 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
7643 or via GDB (default port 3333).
7644
7645 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
7646 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
7647 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
7648
7649 @item @b{Machine Interface}
7650 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
7651 port is 5555.
7652 @end itemize
7653
7654
7655 @section Server Commands
7656
7657 @deffn {Command} exit
7658 Exits the current telnet session.
7659 @end deffn
7660
7661 @deffn {Command} help [string]
7662 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
7663 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
7664 Not every command provides helptext.
7665
7666 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
7667 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
7668 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
7669 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
7670 @end deffn
7671
7672 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
7673 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
7674 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
7675 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
7676 Useful in connection with script files
7677 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
7678 @end deffn
7679
7680 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
7681 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
7682 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
7683 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
7684
7685 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
7686 @example
7687 # redefine shutdown
7688 rename shutdown original_shutdown
7689 proc shutdown @{@} @{
7690 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
7691 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
7692 original_shutdown
7693 @}
7694 @end example
7695 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
7696 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
7697 @end deffn
7698
7699 @anchor{debuglevel}
7700 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
7701 @cindex message level
7702 Display debug level.
7703 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
7704 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
7705 Level 0 is error messages only;
7706 level 1 adds warnings;
7707 level 2 adds informational messages;
7708 level 3 adds debugging messages;
7709 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
7710 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
7711 the command line along with the location of that log
7712 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
7713 @xref{Running}.
7714 @end deffn
7715
7716 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
7717 Logs a message at "user" priority.
7718 Output @var{message} to stdout.
7719 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
7720 @example
7721 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
7722 @end example
7723 @end deffn
7724
7725 @deffn Command log_output [filename]
7726 Redirect logging to @var{filename};
7727 the initial log output channel is stderr.
7728 @end deffn
7729
7730 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
7731 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
7732 @end deffn
7733
7734 @deffn Command bindto [@var{name}]
7735 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
7736 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
7737 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
7738 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
7739 @end deffn
7740
7741 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
7742 @section Target State handling
7743 @cindex reset
7744 @cindex halt
7745 @cindex target initialization
7746
7747 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
7748 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
7749 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
7750 a current target which is used to perform the
7751 various operations. The current target may be changed
7752 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
7753 target which should become current.
7754
7755 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
7756 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
7757 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
7758 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
7759 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
7760
7761 @emph{With no arguments}:
7762 list all available registers for the current target,
7763 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
7764 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
7765 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
7766 are flagged as such.
7767
7768 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
7769 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
7770 bypassing any internal cache.
7771
7772 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
7773 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
7774 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
7775 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
7776 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
7777 relevant module will flush such values.
7778
7779 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
7780 Debug and trace infrastructure:
7781
7782 @example
7783 > reg
7784 ===== ARM registers
7785 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
7786 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
7787 (2) r2 (/32)
7788 ...
7789 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
7790 >
7791 @end example
7792 @end deffn
7793
7794 @deffn Command halt [ms]
7795 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
7796 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
7797 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
7798 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
7799 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
7800 (and enter debug mode).
7801 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
7802
7803 @quotation Warning
7804 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
7805 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
7806 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
7807 power mode by gating the core clock;
7808 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
7809
7810 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
7811 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
7812 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
7813 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
7814 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
7815 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
7816
7817 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
7818 work with a JTAG debugger.
7819 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
7820 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
7821 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
7822 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
7823 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
7824 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
7825 @end quotation
7826
7827 @end deffn
7828
7829 @deffn Command resume [address]
7830 Resume the target at its current code position,
7831 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
7832 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
7833 @end deffn
7834
7835 @deffn Command step [address]
7836 Single-step the target at its current code position,
7837 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
7838 @end deffn
7839
7840 @anchor{resetcommand}
7841 @deffn Command reset
7842 @deffnx Command {reset run}
7843 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
7844 @deffnx Command {reset init}
7845 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
7846 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
7847 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
7848
7849 The optional parameter specifies what should
7850 happen after the reset.
7851 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
7852 The other options will not work on all systems.
7853 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
7854
7855 @itemize @minus
7856 @item @b{run} Let the target run
7857 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
7858 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
7859 @end itemize
7860 @end deffn
7861
7862 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
7863 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
7864 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
7865 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
7866 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
7867 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
7868 state.
7869 @end deffn
7870
7871 @section I/O Utilities
7872
7873 These commands are available when
7874 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
7875 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
7876 notably the ZY1000.
7877 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
7878
7879 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
7880
7881 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
7882 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
7883 the text file @file{filename}.
7884 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
7885 The last string is followed by a newline.
7886 @end deffn
7887
7888 @deffn Command cat filename
7889 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
7890 @end deffn
7891
7892 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
7893 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
7894 into @file{dest_filename}.
7895 @end deffn
7896
7897 @deffn Command ip
7898 @emph{No description provided.}
7899 @end deffn
7900
7901 @deffn Command ls
7902 @emph{No description provided.}
7903 @end deffn
7904
7905 @deffn Command mac
7906 @emph{No description provided.}
7907 @end deffn
7908
7909 @deffn Command meminfo
7910 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
7911 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
7912 @end deffn
7913
7914 @deffn Command peek
7915 @emph{No description provided.}
7916 @end deffn
7917
7918 @deffn Command poke
7919 @emph{No description provided.}
7920 @end deffn
7921
7922 @deffn Command rm filename
7923 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
7924 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
7925 @end deffn
7926
7927 @deffn Command trunc filename
7928 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
7929 @end deffn
7930
7931 @anchor{memoryaccess}
7932 @section Memory access commands
7933 @cindex memory access
7934
7935 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
7936 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
7937 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
7938 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
7939
7940 @enumerate
7941 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
7942 to change the current target.
7943 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
7944 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
7945 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
7946 @end enumerate
7947
7948 @deffn Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
7949 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
7950 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
7951 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
7952 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
7953 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
7954 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
7955 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
7956 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
7957 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
7958 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
7959 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
7960 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
7961 @end deffn
7962
7963 @deffn Command mww [phys] addr word
7964 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword
7965 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte
7966 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
7967 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
7968 at the specified address @var{addr}.
7969 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
7970 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
7971 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
7972 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
7973 @end deffn
7974
7975 @anchor{imageaccess}
7976 @section Image loading commands
7977 @cindex image loading
7978 @cindex image dumping
7979
7980 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
7981 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
7982 binary file named @var{filename}.
7983 @end deffn
7984
7985 @deffn Command {fast_load}
7986 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
7987 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
7988 @end deffn
7989
7990 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
7991 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
7992 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
7993 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
7994 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
7995 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
7996 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
7997 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
7998 separately.
7999 @end deffn
8000
8001 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8002 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8003 The file format may optionally be specified
8004 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
8005 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
8006 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
8007 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
8008 @example
8009 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
8010 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
8011 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
8012 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
8013 $address $length
8014 @}
8015 @end example
8016 @end deffn
8017
8018 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
8019 Displays image section sizes and addresses
8020 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
8021 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
8022 The file format may optionally be specified
8023 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8024 @end deffn
8025
8026 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8027 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8028 The file format may optionally be specified
8029 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8030 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
8031 @end deffn
8032
8033 @deffn Command {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8034 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8035 The file format may optionally be specified
8036 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8037 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
8038 @end deffn
8039
8040
8041 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
8042 @cindex breakpoint
8043 @cindex watchpoint
8044
8045 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
8046 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
8047 watchpoints.
8048 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
8049
8050 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
8051 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
8052 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
8053 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8054 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
8055 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
8056
8057 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
8058 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
8059 @end deffn
8060
8061 @deffn Command {rbp} address
8062 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address}.
8063 @end deffn
8064
8065 @deffn Command {rwp} address
8066 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
8067 @end deffn
8068
8069 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
8070 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
8071 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8072 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
8073 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
8074 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
8075 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
8076 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
8077 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
8078 @end deffn
8079
8080 @section Misc Commands
8081
8082 @cindex profiling
8083 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
8084 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
8085 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
8086 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
8087 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
8088 limit the address range.
8089 @end deffn
8090
8091 @deffn Command {version}
8092 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
8093 @end deffn
8094
8095 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
8096 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
8097 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
8098 @end deffn
8099
8100 @node Architecture and Core Commands
8101 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
8102 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
8103 @cindex Core Specific Commands
8104
8105 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
8106 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
8107 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
8108 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
8109
8110 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
8111 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
8112 @cindex tracing
8113 @cindex ETM
8114 @cindex ETB
8115
8116 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
8117 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
8118 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
8119
8120 @itemize
8121 @item
8122 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
8123 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
8124 supports such an interface.
8125 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
8126 and trace port support.)
8127 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
8128 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
8129 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
8130 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
8131 in the board-specific configuration file.
8132 @item
8133 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8134 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8135 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8136 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8137 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8138 @end itemize
8139
8140 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8141
8142 @quotation Issues
8143 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8144 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8145
8146 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8147 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8148 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8149 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8150 dummy trace port driver}.
8151
8152 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8153 as well as tracing only during specific states
8154 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8155
8156 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8157 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8158 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8159 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8160 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8161
8162 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8163 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8164 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8165 this original style of JTAG access.
8166 @end quotation
8167
8168 @subsection ETM Configuration
8169 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8170
8171 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8172 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8173 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8174
8175 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8176 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8177 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8178 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8179 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8180 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8181 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8182 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8183 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8184
8185 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8186 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8187 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8188
8189 @quotation Warning
8190 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8191 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8192 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8193 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8194 @end quotation
8195
8196 @quotation Note
8197 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8198 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8199 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8200 what CPU activities are traced.
8201 @end quotation
8202 @end deffn
8203
8204 @deffn Command {etm info}
8205 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8206 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8207 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8208 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8209 @end deffn
8210
8211 @deffn Command {etm status}
8212 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8213 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8214 Did trace data overflow?
8215 Was it triggered?
8216 @end deffn
8217
8218 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8219 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8220 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8221 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8222 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8223
8224 @itemize
8225 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8226 when they pass any ViewData filtering that that was set up.
8227 The value is one of
8228 @option{none} (save nothing),
8229 @option{data} (save data),
8230 @option{address} (save addresses),
8231 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8232 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8233 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8234 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8235 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8236 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8237 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8238 trace stream without an image of the code.
8239 @end itemize
8240 @end deffn
8241
8242 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8243 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8244 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8245 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8246 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8247
8248 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8249 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8250 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8251 @end deffn
8252
8253 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8254
8255 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8256 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8257 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8258
8259 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8260 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8261 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8262 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8263 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8264 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8265 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8266
8267 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8268
8269 @itemize
8270 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8271 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8272 for instruction access within that function's body.
8273 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8274 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8275 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8276 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8277 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8278 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8279 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8280 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8281 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8282 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8283 @item @emph{... more}
8284 @end itemize
8285
8286 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8287 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8288
8289 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
8290 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8291 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8292 @end deffn
8293
8294 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
8295 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8296 @end deffn
8297
8298 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8299 Opens an image file.
8300 @end deffn
8301
8302 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
8303 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8304 @end deffn
8305
8306 @deffn Command {etm start}
8307 Starts trace data collection.
8308 @end deffn
8309
8310 @deffn Command {etm stop}
8311 Stops trace data collection.
8312 @end deffn
8313
8314 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
8315 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
8316
8317 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
8318
8319 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
8320 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8321 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
8322 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
8323 any trace data collection.}
8324 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
8325 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
8326 @end deffn
8327 @end deffn
8328
8329 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
8330 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
8331 to use on-chip ETB memory.
8332 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
8333 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
8334 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
8335 @end deffn
8336 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
8337 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
8338 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
8339 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
8340 trace trigger becomes active.
8341
8342 @itemize
8343 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
8344 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
8345 afterwards.
8346 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
8347 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
8348 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
8349 what caused that event to happen.
8350 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
8351 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
8352 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
8353 how the event caused trouble.
8354 @end itemize
8355 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
8356 @end deffn
8357
8358 @end deffn
8359
8360 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
8361 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
8362 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
8363 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
8364 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
8365
8366 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8367 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
8368
8369 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
8370 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
8371 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
8372 @end deffn
8373
8374 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
8375 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
8376 @end deffn
8377
8378 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
8379 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
8380 @end deffn
8381 @end deffn
8382
8383 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
8384 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
8385 @cindex CTI
8386
8387 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
8388 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
8389 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
8390 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
8391 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
8392 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
8393
8394 @deffn Command {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-ctibase} base_address
8395 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
8396 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
8397 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
8398 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
8399 including additional configuration.
8400 @end deffn
8401
8402 @deffn Command {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
8403 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
8404 @end deffn
8405
8406 @deffn Command {$cti_name dump}
8407 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
8408 @end deffn
8409
8410 @deffn Command {$cti_name write } @var{reg_name} @var{value}
8411 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8412 @end deffn
8413
8414 @deffn Command {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
8415 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8416 @end deffn
8417
8418 @deffn Command {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
8419 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
8420 of the CTI.
8421 @end deffn
8422
8423 @deffn Command {cti names}
8424 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
8425 useful in TCL scripting.
8426 @end deffn
8427
8428 @section Generic ARM
8429 @cindex ARM
8430
8431 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
8432 They are available in addition to other core-specific
8433 commands that may be available.
8434
8435 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
8436 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
8437 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
8438 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
8439 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8440 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
8441 @end deffn
8442
8443 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
8444 @cindex disassemble
8445 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
8446 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
8447 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
8448 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
8449 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
8450 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8451 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
8452
8453 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
8454 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
8455 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
8456 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
8457 with a handful of exceptions.
8458 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
8459 @end deffn
8460
8461 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
8462 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
8463 passing parameters @var{CRn},
8464 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8465 and using the MCR instruction.
8466 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8467 an ARM register.)
8468 @end deffn
8469
8470 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
8471 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
8472 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8473 and the MRC instruction.
8474 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
8475 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8476 an ARM register.)
8477 @end deffn
8478
8479 @deffn Command {arm reg}
8480 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
8481 core mode if necessary.
8482 @end deffn
8483
8484 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8485 @cindex ARM semihosting
8486 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
8487
8488 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
8489 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
8490 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
8491 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
8492 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
8493 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
8494 @end deffn
8495
8496 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8497 @cindex ARM semihosting
8498 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
8499
8500 @example
8501 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
8502 @end example
8503
8504 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
8505 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
8506 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
8507 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
8508 @end deffn
8509
8510 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8511 @cindex ARM semihosting
8512 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
8513 status.
8514
8515 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
8516 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
8517 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
8518 debugger.
8519 @end deffn
8520
8521 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8522 @cindex ARM semihosting
8523 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
8524
8525 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
8526 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
8527 the value returned by the target.
8528
8529 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
8530 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
8531 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
8532 encountering a break.
8533
8534 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
8535 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
8536 to the debugger.
8537 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
8538 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
8539 request or equivalent").
8540
8541 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
8542 this option (default: disabled).
8543 @end deffn
8544
8545 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
8546 @cindex ARMv4
8547 @cindex ARMv5
8548
8549 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
8550 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
8551 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
8552 variant.
8553
8554 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
8555 @cindex ARM7
8556 @cindex ARM9
8557
8558 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
8559 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
8560 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
8561 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
8562
8563 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8564 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
8565 the EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
8566 instead of breakpoints.
8567 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8568
8569 This should be
8570 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
8571 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
8572 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
8573 @end deffn
8574
8575 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8576 @cindex DCC
8577 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
8578 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
8579 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8580
8581 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
8582 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
8583 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
8584 @end deffn
8585
8586 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8587 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
8588 that don't check completion of the operation.
8589 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8590
8591 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
8592 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
8593 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
8594 @end deffn
8595
8596 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
8597 @cindex ARM720T
8598
8599 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
8600 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8601 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
8602 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
8603
8604 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
8605 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8606 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8607
8608 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
8609 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8610 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
8611 @end deffn
8612
8613 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
8614 @cindex ARM9
8615
8616 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
8617 integer processors.
8618 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
8619
8620 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
8621 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
8622 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
8623 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
8624
8625 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
8626 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
8627 @cindex vector_catch
8628 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
8629 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
8630 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
8631 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
8632 to those hardware vectors.
8633
8634 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
8635 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
8636 vector catch hardware to intercept
8637 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
8638 @option{none} of them,
8639 or a list with one or more of the following:
8640 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
8641 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
8642 @end deffn
8643
8644 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
8645 @cindex ARM920T
8646
8647 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
8648 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8649 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
8650 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8651 and ARM9 commands.
8652
8653 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
8654 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
8655 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
8656 @end deffn
8657
8658 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
8659 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8660 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8661 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
8662 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
8663 (Not all registers can be written.)
8664 @end deffn
8665
8666 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
8667 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8668 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8669
8670 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
8671 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
8672 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
8673 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
8674 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
8675 or using zero if no other address is provided.
8676 @end deffn
8677
8678 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
8679 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
8680 @end deffn
8681
8682 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
8683 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
8684 @end deffn
8685
8686 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
8687 @cindex ARM926ej-s
8688
8689 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
8690 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
8691 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
8692 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8693 and ARM9 commands.
8694
8695 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
8696 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
8697
8698 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
8699 Print information about the caches found.
8700 @end deffn
8701
8702 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
8703 @cindex ARM966E
8704
8705 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
8706 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
8707 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8708 and ARM9 commands.
8709
8710 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
8711 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8712 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8713 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
8714 ARM966E-S TRM.
8715 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
8716 as required for BIST support.
8717 @end deffn
8718
8719 @subsection XScale specific commands
8720 @cindex XScale
8721
8722 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
8723
8724 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
8725 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
8726 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
8727 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
8728 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
8729 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
8730 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
8731
8732 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
8733 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
8734 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
8735 the mini-IC.
8736
8737 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
8738 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
8739 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
8740 code layout in memory:
8741 @example
8742 _vectors:
8743 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8744 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8745 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8746 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8747 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8748 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8749 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8750 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8751 .org 0x100
8752 .long real_reset_vector
8753 .long real_ui_handler
8754 .long real_swi_handler
8755 .long real_pf_abort
8756 .long real_data_abort
8757 .long 0 /* unused */
8758 .long real_irq_handler
8759 .long real_fiq_handler
8760 @end example
8761
8762 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
8763 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
8764 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
8765 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
8766 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
8767 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
8768 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
8769 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
8770 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
8771 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
8772 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
8773 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
8774 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
8775 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
8776 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
8777 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
8778 software.
8779
8780 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
8781 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
8782 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
8783 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
8784
8785 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
8786 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
8787 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
8788 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
8789 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
8790 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
8791 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
8792 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
8793 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
8794
8795 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
8796 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
8797
8798 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
8799 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
8800 @end deffn
8801
8802 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
8803 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
8804 @end deffn
8805
8806 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
8807 Displays information about the CPU caches.
8808 @end deffn
8809
8810 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
8811 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8812 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8813 @end deffn
8814
8815 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
8816 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
8817 @end deffn
8818
8819 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8820 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
8821 @end deffn
8822
8823 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
8824 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
8825 @end deffn
8826
8827 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8828 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
8829 @end deffn
8830
8831 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8832 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
8833 @end deffn
8834
8835 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
8836 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
8837 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
8838 and modifying how it is emptied.
8839 @end deffn
8840
8841 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
8842 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
8843 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
8844 The image @var{type} may be one of
8845 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
8846 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
8847 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
8848 @end deffn
8849
8850 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
8851 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
8852 @cindex vector_catch
8853 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
8854 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
8855
8856 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
8857 @example
8858 0x01 Trap Reset
8859 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
8860 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
8861 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
8862 0x10 Trap Data Abort
8863 0x20 reserved
8864 0x40 Trap IRQ
8865 0x80 Trap FIQ
8866 @end example
8867 @end deffn
8868
8869 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
8870 @cindex vector_table
8871
8872 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
8873 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
8874 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
8875 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
8876 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
8877
8878 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
8879
8880 @end deffn
8881
8882 @section ARMv6 Architecture
8883 @cindex ARMv6
8884
8885 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
8886 @cindex ARM11
8887
8888 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8889 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
8890 which is enabled by default.
8891 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8892 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
8893 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
8894 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
8895 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
8896 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
8897 @end deffn
8898
8899 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8900 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
8901 which is enabled by default.
8902 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8903 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
8904 @end deffn
8905
8906 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8907 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
8908 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
8909 they are disabled by default.
8910 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
8911 @end deffn
8912
8913 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
8914 @cindex vector_catch
8915 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
8916 coprocessor 14 register 7.
8917 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
8918
8919 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
8920 for certain hardware events.
8921 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
8922 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
8923 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
8924 @end deffn
8925
8926 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
8927 @cindex ARMv7
8928 @cindex ARMv8
8929
8930 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
8931 @cindex Cortex-A
8932
8933 @deffn Command {cortex_a cache_info}
8934 display information about target caches
8935 @end deffn
8936
8937 @deffn Command {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
8938 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
8939 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
8940 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
8941 Defaults to 'off'.
8942 @end deffn
8943
8944 @deffn Command {cortex_a dbginit}
8945 Initialize core debug
8946 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
8947 @end deffn
8948
8949 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
8950 Display/set the current SMP mode
8951 @end deffn
8952
8953 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
8954 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
8955 @end deffn
8956
8957 @deffn Command {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
8958 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
8959 @end deffn
8960
8961 @deffn Command {cache_config l2x} [base way]
8962 configure l2x cache
8963 @end deffn
8964
8965 @deffn Command {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
8966 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
8967 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
8968 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
8969 possible (4096) entries are printed.
8970 @end deffn
8971
8972 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
8973 @cindex Cortex-R
8974
8975 @deffn Command {cortex_r dbginit}
8976 Initialize core debug
8977 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
8978 @end deffn
8979
8980 @deffn Command {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
8981 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
8982 @end deffn
8983
8984
8985 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
8986 @cindex tracing
8987 @cindex SWO
8988 @cindex SWV
8989 @cindex TPIU
8990 @cindex ITM
8991 @cindex ETM
8992
8993 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal (@var{filename} | -)}) @
8994 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
8995 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
8996
8997 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
8998 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
8999 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
9000 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
9001
9002 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
9003 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
9004 debugger adapter features.
9005
9006 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
9007 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
9008
9009 Command options:
9010 @itemize @minus
9011 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
9012 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
9013 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware);
9014 @item @option{internal @var{filename}} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
9015 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename} (which can be
9016 either a regular file or a named pipe);
9017 @item @option{internal -} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
9018 gather trace data, but not write to any file. Useful in conjunction with the @command{tcl_trace} command;
9019 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
9020 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width};
9021 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
9022 coding;
9023 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
9024 regular UART 8N1) coding;
9025 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
9026 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
9027 data is to be output via SWO;
9028 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
9029 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK);
9030 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
9031 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
9032 rate automatically.
9033 @end itemize
9034
9035 Example usage:
9036 @enumerate
9037 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
9038 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
9039 enough to:
9040 @example
9041 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
9042 ...
9043 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
9044 ...
9045 @end example
9046 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
9047 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
9048 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
9049 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
9050 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
9051 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
9052 @example
9053 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
9054 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
9055 @end example
9056 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
9057 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
9058 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
9059 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
9060 @example
9061 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
9062 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
9063 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
9064 -c "tpiu config external uart off 24000000 12000000"
9065 @end example
9066 @end enumerate
9067 @end deffn
9068
9069 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9070 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
9071 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
9072 @end deffn
9073
9074 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9075 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
9076 @end deffn
9077
9078 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
9079 @cindex Cortex-M
9080
9081 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
9082 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
9083
9084 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
9085 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
9086 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
9087 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
9088 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
9089 the step command leaves with the core running.
9090
9091 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
9092 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
9093 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
9094 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
9095
9096 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
9097 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
9098 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
9099 does.
9100
9101 Default is @option{auto}.
9102 @end deffn
9103
9104 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9105 @cindex vector_catch
9106 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9107 for certain hardware events.
9108
9109 Parameters request interception of
9110 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
9111 @option{none} of them,
9112 or one or more of the following:
9113 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
9114 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
9115 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
9116 @option{irq_err},
9117 @option{state_err},
9118 @option{chk_err}, or
9119 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
9120 @option{reset}.
9121 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
9122 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
9123 are mapped to HardFault.
9124 UsageFault checks for
9125 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
9126 must also be explicitly enabled.
9127
9128 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
9129 @end deffn
9130
9131 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
9132 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
9133 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
9134
9135 @itemize @minus
9136 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9137 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
9138 @end itemize
9139
9140 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
9141 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9142 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
9143 to manually reset the peripherals.
9144 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9145
9146 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
9147 instead.
9148 @end deffn
9149
9150 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9151 @cindex ARMv8-A
9152 @cindex aarch64
9153
9154 @deffn Command {aarch64 cache_info}
9155 Display information about target caches
9156 @end deffn
9157
9158 @deffn Command {aarch64 dbginit}
9159 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9160 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9161 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9162 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9163 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9164 @end deffn
9165
9166 @deffn Command {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
9167 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9168 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9169 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9170 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9171 @end deffn
9172
9173 @deffn Command {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9174 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9175 @option{on}.
9176 @end deffn
9177
9178 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9179
9180 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9181 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9182
9183 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9184
9185 @deffn Command {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9186 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9187 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9188 @end deffn
9189
9190 @deffn Command {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9191 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9192 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9193 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9194 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9195 @end deffn
9196
9197 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
9198
9199 @deffn Command {esirisc flush_caches}
9200 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9201 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9202 @end deffn
9203
9204 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
9205
9206 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
9207 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
9208 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
9209 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
9210 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
9211 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
9212 can be collected.
9213
9214 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
9215 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
9216 tooling.
9217
9218 @quotation Issues
9219 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
9220 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
9221 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
9222 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
9223
9224 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
9225 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
9226 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
9227 software operation on the CPU.
9228 @end quotation
9229
9230 @deffn Command {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
9231 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
9232 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
9233 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
9234 @end deffn
9235
9236 @deffn Command {esirisc trace fifo} address
9237 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
9238 @end deffn
9239
9240 @deffn Command {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9241 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
9242 control is disabled.
9243 @end deffn
9244
9245 @deffn Command {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
9246 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
9247 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
9248 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
9249
9250 Supported trace formats:
9251 @itemize
9252 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
9253 timing to be determined.
9254 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
9255 addresses.
9256 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
9257 @end itemize
9258 @end deffn
9259
9260 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
9261 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
9262 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
9263 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9264
9265 Supported conditions:
9266 @itemize
9267 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
9268 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
9269 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
9270 instruction matches start data and mask.
9271 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
9272 instruction matches start data and mask.
9273 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
9274 data and mask.
9275 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9276 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9277 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9278 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
9279 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
9280 @end itemize
9281 @end deffn
9282
9283 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
9284 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
9285 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
9286 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9287
9288 Supported conditions:
9289 @itemize
9290 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
9291 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
9292 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
9293 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9294 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
9295 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9296 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
9297 data and mask.
9298 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9299 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9300 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9301 @end itemize
9302 @end deffn
9303
9304 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
9305 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
9306
9307 Supported triggers:
9308 @itemize
9309 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
9310 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
9311 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
9312 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
9313 collection.
9314 @end itemize
9315 @end deffn
9316
9317 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
9318
9319 @deffn Command {esirisc trace init}
9320 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
9321 configuration changes. If an trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
9322 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
9323 @end deffn
9324
9325 @deffn Command {esirisc trace info}
9326 Display trace configuration.
9327 @end deffn
9328
9329 @deffn Command {esirisc trace status}
9330 Display trace collection status.
9331 @end deffn
9332
9333 @deffn Command {esirisc trace start}
9334 Start manual trace collection.
9335 @end deffn
9336
9337 @deffn Command {esirisc trace stop}
9338 Stop manual trace collection.
9339 @end deffn
9340
9341 @deffn Command {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
9342 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
9343 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
9344 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9345 @option{size} options using DMA.
9346 @end deffn
9347
9348 @deffn Command {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
9349 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
9350 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
9351 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9352 @option{size} options using DMA.
9353 @end deffn
9354
9355 @deffn Command {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
9356 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
9357 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
9358 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
9359 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
9360 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
9361 @end deffn
9362
9363 @section Intel Architecture
9364
9365 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
9366 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
9367 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
9368 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
9369 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
9370 @itemize
9371 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
9372 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
9373 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
9374 @end itemize
9375
9376 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
9377 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
9378 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
9379
9380 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
9381 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9382 @end deffn
9383
9384 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
9385 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9386 @end deffn
9387
9388 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
9389 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9390 @end deffn
9391
9392 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
9393 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9394 @end deffn
9395
9396 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
9397 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9398 @end deffn
9399
9400 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
9401 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9402 @end deffn
9403
9404 @section OpenRISC Architecture
9405
9406 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
9407 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
9408
9409 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
9410 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
9411 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
9412 @end deffn
9413 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
9414 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
9415
9416 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
9417
9418 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
9419 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
9420 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
9421 @end deffn
9422
9423 @subsection Registers commands
9424 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
9425 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
9426 included in the generated target descriptor file.
9427
9428 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
9429
9430 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
9431 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
9432 and "timer" groups.
9433
9434 @emph{example:}
9435 @example
9436 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
9437 @end example
9438
9439
9440 @end deffn
9441 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
9442 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
9443
9444 @emph{group} can be "system",
9445 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
9446 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
9447 @end deffn
9448
9449 @section RISC-V Architecture
9450
9451 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
9452 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
9453 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
9454 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
9455 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
9456 implement version 0.11.
9457
9458 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
9459
9460 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
9461 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
9462 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
9463
9464 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
9465
9466 @deffn Command {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9467 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
9468 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
9469
9470 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
9471 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
9472 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
9473 CSRs.
9474 @end deffn
9475
9476 @deffn Command {riscv expose_custom} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9477 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
9478 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
9479 configures a list of inclusive ranges of those registers to expose. Number 0
9480 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
9481 This command must be executed before `init`.
9482 @end deffn
9483
9484 @deffn Command {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9485 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
9486 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
9487 @end deffn
9488
9489 @deffn Command {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9490 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
9491 deasserted.
9492 @end deffn
9493
9494 @deffn Command {riscv set_scratch_ram} none|[address]
9495 Set the address of 16 bytes of scratch RAM the debugger can use, or 'none'.
9496 This is used to access 64-bit floating point registers on 32-bit targets.
9497 @end deffn
9498
9499 @deffn Command {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
9500 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off, prefer to
9501 use the Program Buffer to access memory.
9502 @end deffn
9503
9504 @deffn Command {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
9505 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
9506 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
9507 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
9508 values.
9509
9510 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
9511 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
9512 and DBUS registers, respectively.
9513 @end deffn
9514
9515 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
9516
9517 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
9518 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
9519 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
9520 @example
9521 set challenge [ocd_riscv authdata_read]
9522 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
9523 @end example
9524
9525 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_read}
9526 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata. Note that to get read value back in
9527 a TCL script, it needs to be invoked as @command{ocd_riscv authdata_read}.
9528 @end deffn
9529
9530 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_write} value
9531 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
9532 @end deffn
9533
9534 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
9535
9536 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
9537 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
9538
9539 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_read}
9540 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value. Note that to get
9541 read value back in a TCL script, it needs to be invoked as @command{ocd_riscv
9542 dmi_read}.
9543 @end deffn
9544
9545 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_write} address value
9546 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
9547 @end deffn
9548
9549 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
9550 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
9551 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
9552 @cindex tracing
9553 @cindex libdcc
9554 @cindex DCC
9555 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
9556 the target uses appropriate libraries.
9557 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
9558 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
9559
9560 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
9561 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
9562 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
9563 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
9564 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
9565 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
9566
9567 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
9568 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
9569 arrays of various size integers from the target,
9570 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
9571 The target being debugged may
9572 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
9573 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
9574 each supported by a command:
9575
9576 @itemize
9577 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
9578 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
9579 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
9580 finding out how some fault was triggered.
9581
9582 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
9583 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
9584 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
9585
9586 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
9587 and then displayed at any time.
9588 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
9589
9590 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
9591 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
9592 @end itemize
9593
9594 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
9595 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
9596 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
9597 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
9598 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
9599 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
9600 does the same thing.
9601
9602 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
9603 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
9604 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
9605 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
9606 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
9607
9608 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
9609 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
9610 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
9611 @end deffn
9612
9613 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
9614 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
9615 in the order they triggered.
9616 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
9617 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
9618 history records.
9619 @end deffn
9620
9621 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
9622 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
9623 they have been triggered.
9624 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
9625 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
9626 and associates it with that identifier.
9627
9628 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
9629 are not related except by this command.
9630 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
9631 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
9632 @end deffn
9633
9634
9635 @node JTAG Commands
9636 @chapter JTAG Commands
9637 @cindex JTAG Commands
9638 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
9639 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
9640 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
9641 may be needed to work with targets which require special
9642 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
9643
9644 To use these commands you will need to understand some
9645 of the basics of JTAG, including:
9646
9647 @itemize @bullet
9648 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
9649 devices such as a CPUs.
9650 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
9651 standard state machine (in parallel)
9652 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
9653 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
9654 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
9655 while the reading previous ones.
9656 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
9657 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
9658 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
9659 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
9660 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
9661 registers.
9662 @end itemize
9663
9664 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
9665
9666 These commands are used by developers who need to access
9667 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
9668 the order of TAP state transitions.
9669 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
9670 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
9671 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
9672 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
9673 these commands are not available.
9674
9675 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
9676 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
9677 that specify the entire register.
9678 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
9679 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
9680 The return value holds the original value of each
9681 of those fields.
9682
9683 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
9684 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
9685 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
9686 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
9687 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
9688
9689 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
9690 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
9691
9692 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
9693 in that state.
9694 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
9695 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
9696 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
9697
9698 @quotation Warning
9699 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
9700 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
9701 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
9702 data registers, which may have different lengths.
9703 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
9704 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
9705 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
9706 (by connecting a different scan chain).
9707 @end quotation
9708 @end deffn
9709
9710 @deffn Command {flush_count}
9711 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
9712 This may be used for performance tuning.
9713
9714 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
9715 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
9716 not change with the amount of data which is written.
9717 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
9718 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
9719 instead of batching them into larger operations.
9720 @end deffn
9721
9722 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
9723 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
9724 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
9725 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
9726 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
9727 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
9728
9729 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
9730 in that state.
9731 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
9732 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
9733 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
9734
9735 @quotation Note
9736 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
9737 register values, unlike data register values.
9738 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
9739 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
9740 @end quotation
9741 @end deffn
9742
9743 @deffn Command {jtag_reset} trst srst
9744 Set values of reset signals.
9745 The @var{trst} and @var{srst} parameter values may be
9746 @option{0}, indicating that reset is inactive (pulled or driven high),
9747 or @option{1}, indicating it is active (pulled or driven low).
9748 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
9749 to configure how the board and JTAG adapter treat these two
9750 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
9751 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
9752
9753 Note that TRST is specially handled.
9754 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
9755 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
9756 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
9757 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
9758 instead of the TRST signal.
9759 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
9760 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
9761 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
9762 with handlers for that event.
9763 @end deffn
9764
9765 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
9766 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
9767 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
9768 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
9769 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
9770 Then, in a series of single state transitions
9771 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
9772 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
9773 The final state must also be stable.
9774 @end deffn
9775
9776 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
9777 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
9778 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
9779 Instructions often need some time
9780 to execute before they take effect.
9781 @end deffn
9782
9783 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
9784 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
9785
9786 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9787 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
9788 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
9789 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
9790 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
9791 @end deffn
9792
9793 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9794 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
9795 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
9796 must also be enabled.
9797 Default is enabled.
9798 @end deffn
9799
9800 @section TAP state names
9801 @cindex TAP state names
9802
9803 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
9804 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
9805 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
9806 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
9807
9808 @itemize @bullet
9809 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
9810 acts as if TRST were pulsed
9811 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
9812 @item @b{DRSELECT}
9813 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
9814 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
9815 through the data register
9816 @item @b{DREXIT1}
9817 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
9818 for update or more shifting
9819 @item @b{DREXIT2}
9820 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
9821 @item @b{IRSELECT}
9822 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
9823 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
9824 through the instruction register
9825 @item @b{IREXIT1}
9826 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
9827 for update or more shifting
9828 @item @b{IREXIT2}
9829 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
9830 @end itemize
9831
9832 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
9833 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
9834 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
9835 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
9836
9837 @itemize @bullet
9838 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
9839 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
9840 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
9841 may not be as expected.
9842 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
9843 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
9844 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
9845 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
9846 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
9847 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
9848 @end itemize
9849
9850 @node Boundary Scan Commands
9851 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
9852
9853 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
9854 boundary scan based hardware testing.
9855 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
9856 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
9857
9858 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
9859 @cindex Serial Vector Format
9860 @cindex SVF
9861
9862 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
9863 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
9864 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
9865 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
9866
9867 @deffn Command {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
9868 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
9869 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
9870 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
9871
9872 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
9873 affect their semantics.
9874
9875 Command options:
9876 @itemize @minus
9877 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
9878 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
9879 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
9880 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
9881 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
9882 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
9883 on the real interface;
9884 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
9885 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
9886 errors.
9887 @end itemize
9888 @end deffn
9889
9890 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
9891 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
9892 @cindex XSVF
9893
9894 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
9895 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
9896 Xilinx devices.
9897 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
9898 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
9899
9900 @quotation Important
9901 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
9902 @end quotation
9903
9904 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
9905 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
9906 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
9907 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
9908 that TAP.
9909 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
9910 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
9911 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
9912 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
9913 @end deffn
9914
9915 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
9916 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
9917 after building the software.
9918 You may find them useful:
9919
9920 @itemize
9921 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
9922 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
9923 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
9924 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
9925 @end itemize
9926
9927 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
9928 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
9929 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
9930 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
9931 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
9932 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
9933 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
9934
9935
9936 @node Utility Commands
9937 @chapter Utility Commands
9938 @cindex Utility Commands
9939
9940 @section RAM testing
9941 @cindex RAM testing
9942
9943 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
9944 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
9945 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
9946 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
9947 hardware problems.
9948
9949 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
9950 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
9951 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
9952 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
9953
9954 Load the memory testing functions with
9955
9956 @example
9957 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
9958 @end example
9959
9960 to get access to the following facilities:
9961
9962 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
9963 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
9964 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
9965 @end deffn
9966
9967 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
9968 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
9969 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
9970 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
9971 @end deffn
9972
9973 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
9974 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
9975 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
9976 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
9977 @end deffn
9978
9979 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
9980 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
9981 @end deffn
9982
9983 @section Firmware recovery helpers
9984 @cindex Firmware recovery
9985
9986 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
9987 devices recovery with JTAG.
9988
9989 For quickstart instructions run:
9990 @example
9991 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
9992 @end example
9993
9994 @node TFTP
9995 @chapter TFTP
9996 @cindex TFTP
9997 If OpenOCD runs on an embedded host (as ZY1000 does), then TFTP can
9998 be used to access files on PCs (either the developer's PC or some other PC).
9999
10000 The way this works on the ZY1000 is to prefix a filename by
10001 "/tftp/ip/" and append the TFTP path on the TFTP
10002 server (tftpd). For example,
10003
10004 @example
10005 load_image /tftp/10.0.0.96/c:\temp\abc.elf
10006 @end example
10007
10008 will load c:\temp\abc.elf from the developer pc (10.0.0.96) into memory as
10009 if the file was hosted on the embedded host.
10010
10011 In order to achieve decent performance, you must choose a TFTP server
10012 that supports a packet size bigger than the default packet size (512 bytes). There
10013 are numerous TFTP servers out there (free and commercial) and you will have to do
10014 a bit of googling to find something that fits your requirements.
10015
10016 @node GDB and OpenOCD
10017 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
10018 @cindex GDB
10019 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
10020 to debug remote targets.
10021 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
10022
10023 @itemize
10024 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
10025 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
10026 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
10027 as shown in this chapter.
10028 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
10029 that also will probably need to be configured.
10030 @end itemize
10031
10032 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
10033 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
10034 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
10035 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
10036 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
10037 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
10038
10039 @section Connecting to GDB
10040 @cindex Connecting to GDB
10041 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
10042 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
10043 errors, which has since been fixed; see
10044 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
10045
10046 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
10047
10048 @enumerate
10049 @item
10050 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
10051 @example
10052 target remote localhost:3333
10053 @end example
10054 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
10055
10056 It is also possible to use the GDB extended remote protocol as follows:
10057 @example
10058 target extended-remote localhost:3333
10059 @end example
10060 @item
10061 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
10062 @example
10063 target remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
10064 @end example
10065 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
10066 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
10067 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
10068 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
10069 @end enumerate
10070
10071 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
10072 GDB command line.
10073
10074 @section Sample GDB session startup
10075
10076 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
10077 than they do when you're debugging locally.
10078 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
10079 small ARM program.
10080 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
10081 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
10082
10083 @example
10084 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
10085 (gdb) target remote localhost:3333
10086 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
10087 ...
10088 (gdb) monitor reset halt
10089 ...
10090 (gdb) load
10091 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
10092 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
10093 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
10094 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
10095 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
10096 (gdb) continue
10097 Continuing.
10098 ...
10099 @end example
10100
10101 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
10102 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
10103 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
10104 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
10105
10106 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
10107
10108 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
10109 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
10110 packet size and the device's memory map.
10111 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
10112 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
10113 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
10114
10115 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
10116 You may need to set those up by hand.
10117 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
10118 something like:
10119
10120 @example
10121 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
10122 @end example
10123
10124 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
10125
10126 @example
10127 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
10128 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
10129 @end example
10130
10131 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
10132 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
10133 do not have such restrictions.
10134
10135 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
10136 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
10137 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
10138 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
10139
10140 @section Programming using GDB
10141 @cindex Programming using GDB
10142 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
10143
10144 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
10145 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
10146 @example
10147 gdb_memory_map disable
10148 @end example
10149 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
10150 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
10151 working area.
10152
10153 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
10154 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
10155 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
10156 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
10157
10158 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
10159 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
10160
10161 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
10162 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
10163 @example
10164 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
10165 @end example
10166
10167 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
10168 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
10169
10170 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
10171 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
10172 will be used.
10173
10174 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
10175 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
10176 @example
10177 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
10178 @end example
10179 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
10180
10181 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
10182 can be used.
10183
10184 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10185 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10186 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
10187
10188 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
10189 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
10190 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
10191
10192 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
10193 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
10194 and GDB treats it as it were running.
10195 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
10196 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
10197 without any intrusion of the target process.
10198
10199 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
10200 Place following command after target configuration:
10201 @example
10202 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
10203 @end example
10204
10205 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
10206 switch off gdb_memory_map:
10207 @example
10208 gdb_memory_map disable
10209 @end example
10210
10211 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
10212 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
10213 @example
10214 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
10215 @end example
10216
10217 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
10218 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
10219
10220 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target remote ...} and inspect memory
10221 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
10222 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
10223 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
10224
10225 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
10226 previously shown varibles.
10227
10228 @section RTOS Support
10229 @cindex RTOS Support
10230 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
10231
10232 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
10233 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
10234
10235 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
10236 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
10237 GDB commands.
10238
10239 @* An example setup is below:
10240
10241 @example
10242 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
10243 @end example
10244
10245 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
10246
10247 Currently supported rtos's include:
10248 @itemize @bullet
10249 @item @option{eCos}
10250 @item @option{ThreadX}
10251 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
10252 @item @option{linux}
10253 @item @option{ChibiOS}
10254 @item @option{embKernel}
10255 @item @option{mqx}
10256 @item @option{uCOS-III}
10257 @item @option{nuttx}
10258 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
10259 @end itemize
10260
10261 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
10262 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
10263
10264 @table @code
10265 @item eCos symbols
10266 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
10267 @item ThreadX symbols
10268 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
10269 @item FreeRTOS symbols
10270 @c The following is taken from recent texinfo to provide compatibility
10271 @c with ancient versions that do not support @raggedright
10272 @tex
10273 \begingroup
10274 \rightskip0pt plus2em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
10275 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
10276 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
10277 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
10278 \par
10279 \endgroup
10280 @end tex
10281 @item linux symbols
10282 init_task.
10283 @item ChibiOS symbols
10284 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
10285 @item embKernel symbols
10286 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
10287 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
10288 @item mqx symbols
10289 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
10290 @item uC/OS-III symbols
10291 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty
10292 @item nuttx symbols
10293 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable
10294 @end table
10295
10296 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
10297 some, eg. FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III, extra steps must be taken.
10298
10299 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
10300 along with the project:
10301
10302 @table @code
10303 @item FreeRTOS
10304 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
10305 @item uC/OS-III
10306 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
10307 @end table
10308
10309 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
10310 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
10311 @cindex SMP
10312 @cindex RTOS
10313 @cindex hwthread
10314 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
10315 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
10316 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
10317 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
10318 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
10319 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
10320 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
10321 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
10322 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
10323
10324 @section Legacy SMP core switching support
10325 @quotation Note
10326 This method is deprecated in favor of the @emph{hwthread} pseudo RTOS.
10327 @end quotation
10328
10329 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
10330 @itemize @bullet
10331 @item j - smp status request
10332 @item J - smp set request
10333 @end itemize
10334
10335 OpenOCD implements :
10336 @itemize @bullet
10337 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
10338 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
10339 @option{E01} for target not smp.
10340 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
10341 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
10342 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
10343 @end itemize
10344
10345 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
10346 @itemize @bullet
10347 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
10348 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
10349 @example
10350 set $_core 1
10351 #Jc01 packet is sent
10352 print $_core
10353 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
10354 @end example
10355
10356 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
10357 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
10358
10359 @example
10360 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
10361 define toggle0
10362 maint packet Jc0
10363 continue
10364 main packet Jc-1
10365 end
10366 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
10367 define toggle1
10368 maint packet Jc1
10369 continue
10370 main packet Jc-1
10371 end
10372 @end example
10373 @end itemize
10374
10375 @node Tcl Scripting API
10376 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
10377 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
10378 @cindex Tcl scripts
10379 @section API rules
10380
10381 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
10382 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
10383 of state information as an argument to each proc.
10384
10385 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
10386 pair list and lists.
10387
10388 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
10389 list.
10390
10391 @example
10392 > set foo(me) Duane
10393 > set foo(you) Oyvind
10394 > set foo(mouse) Micky
10395 > set foo(duck) Donald
10396 @end example
10397
10398 If one does this:
10399
10400 @example
10401 > set foo
10402 @end example
10403
10404 The result is:
10405
10406 @example
10407 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
10408 @end example
10409
10410 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
10411
10412 @verbatim
10413 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
10414 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
10415 }
10416 @end verbatim
10417
10418 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
10419 should be passed in to the proc in question.
10420
10421 @section Internal low-level Commands
10422
10423 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
10424 invoke directly.
10425
10426 Some low-level commands need to be prefixed with "ocd_"; e.g.
10427 @command{ocd_flash_banks}
10428 is the low-level API upon which @command{flash banks} is implemented.
10429
10430 @itemize @bullet
10431 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
10432
10433 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
10434 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
10435
10436 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
10437 @item @b{ocd_flash_banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
10438
10439 Return information about the flash banks
10440
10441 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
10442
10443 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
10444 its execution. Example:
10445
10446 @example
10447 > capture "reset init"
10448 @end example
10449
10450 @end itemize
10451
10452 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
10453 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
10454 called "flash_banks".
10455
10456 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
10457
10458 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
10459 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
10460 holds one of the following values:
10461
10462 @itemize @bullet
10463 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
10464 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating system.
10465 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
10466 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
10467 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
10468 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating system
10469 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
10470 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
10471 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
10472 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
10473 @end itemize
10474
10475 Note: 'winxx' was chosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
10476
10477 @quotation Note
10478 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
10479 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
10480 @code{jim_platform} (because it
10481 is jim, not real tcl).
10482 @end quotation
10483
10484 @section Tcl RPC server
10485 @cindex RPC
10486
10487 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
10488 commands and receive the results.
10489
10490 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
10491 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
10492 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
10493 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
10494 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
10495
10496 Remember that most of the OpenOCD commands need to be prefixed with
10497 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. Sometimes you might also need the
10498 @command{capture} command.
10499
10500 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
10501
10502 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
10503 @cindex RPC Notifications
10504
10505 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
10506 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
10507
10508 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
10509 in the following format.
10510
10511 @verbatim
10512 type target_event event [event-name]
10513 type target_state state [state-name]
10514 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
10515 @end verbatim
10516
10517 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
10518 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
10519 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
10520 Defaults to off.
10521
10522 @end deffn
10523
10524 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
10525 @cindex RPC trace output
10526
10527 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
10528 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
10529
10530 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
10531
10532 @verbatim
10533 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
10534 @end verbatim
10535
10536 @deffn {Command} tcl_trace [on/off]
10537 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
10538 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
10539 Defaults to off.
10540
10541 See an example application here:
10542 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
10543
10544 @end deffn
10545
10546 @node FAQ
10547 @chapter FAQ
10548 @cindex faq
10549 @enumerate
10550 @anchor{faqrtck}
10551 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
10552 @cindex RTCK
10553 @cindex adaptive clocking
10554 @*
10555
10556 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
10557 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
10558 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
10559 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
10560
10561 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
10562 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
10563 for example. There are 2 basic options:
10564 @enumerate
10565 @item
10566 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
10567 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
10568 @item
10569 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
10570 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
10571 @end enumerate
10572
10573 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
10574 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
10575 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
10576 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
10577 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
10578 power).
10579
10580 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
10581 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
10582 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
10583 ARM926 scenario).
10584 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
10585 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
10586 JTAG can use a faster clock.
10587
10588 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
10589 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
10590 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
10591 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
10592
10593 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
10594
10595 In order to make use of this,
10596 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
10597 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
10598
10599 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
10600 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
10601 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
10602 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
10603 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
10604
10605 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
10606 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
10607 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
10608 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
10609
10610 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
10611 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
10612 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
10613 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
10614 with a CPLD.
10615 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
10616 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
10617 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
10618 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
10619 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
10620 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
10621
10622 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
10623
10624 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
10625
10626 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
10627 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
10628 depending on the chips on your board.
10629 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
10630 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
10631 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
10632
10633 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
10634 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
10635 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
10636
10637 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
10638 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
10639 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
10640 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
10641
10642 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
10643 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
10644 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
10645 this way.
10646
10647 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
10648 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
10649 clock rate.
10650 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
10651 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
10652 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
10653
10654 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
10655
10656 @example
10657 # Example: 1.234MHz
10658 adapter_khz 1234
10659 @end example
10660
10661
10662 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
10663
10664 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
10665 around Windows filenames.
10666
10667 @example
10668 > echo \a
10669
10670 > echo @{\a@}
10671 \a
10672 > echo "\a"
10673
10674 >
10675 @end example
10676
10677
10678 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
10679
10680 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
10681 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
10682 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
10683
10684 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
10685 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
10686 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
10687
10688 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
10689 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
10690 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
10691
10692 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
10693
10694 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
10695 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
10696 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
10697 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
10698
10699 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
10700 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
10701 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
10702
10703 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
10704 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
10705
10706 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
10707 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
10708 memory read caused data abort".
10709
10710 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
10711 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
10712 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
10713 be done, feel free to add this here.
10714
10715 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
10716 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
10717 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
10718 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
10719 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
10720 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
10721 gracefully stops.
10722
10723 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
10724 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
10725 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
10726
10727 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
10728 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
10729 bytes. Painful...
10730
10731
10732 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
10733 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
10734
10735 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
10736 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{jtag_reset
10737 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
10738 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
10739 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
10740 reset, everything else should work fine.
10741
10742 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
10743 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
10744 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
10745 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
10746
10747 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
10748 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
10749 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
10750 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
10751
10752 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
10753
10754 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
10755 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
10756 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
10757
10758 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
10759 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
10760
10761 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
10762 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
10763 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
10764 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
10765 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
10766 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
10767 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
10768 clock frequency?
10769
10770 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
10771 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
10772 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
10773 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
10774 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
10775
10776 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
10777
10778 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
10779 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
10780 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
10781 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
10782 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
10783 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
10784 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
10785
10786 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
10787
10788 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
10789 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
10790 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
10791 up DRAM and loading it with code.
10792
10793 @anchor{faqtaporder}
10794 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
10795 particular order?
10796
10797 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
10798 the same order used by the hardware.
10799
10800 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
10801 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
10802 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
10803 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
10804 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
10805 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
10806
10807 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
10808 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
10809 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
10810 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
10811
10812 @itemize @bullet
10813 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
10814 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
10815 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
10816 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
10817 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
10818 @end itemize
10819
10820 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
10821
10822 @itemize @bullet
10823 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
10824 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
10825 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
10826 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
10827 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
10828 @end itemize
10829
10830
10831 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
10832 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
10833 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
10834
10835 TODO.
10836
10837 @end enumerate
10838
10839 @node Tcl Crash Course
10840 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
10841 @cindex Tcl
10842
10843 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
10844 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
10845 how the Tcl scripts work.
10846
10847 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
10848 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
10849 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
10850 OpenOCD.
10851
10852 @section Tcl Rule #1
10853 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
10854 @enumerate
10855 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
10856 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10857 @end enumerate
10858
10859 The Tcl equal is this:
10860
10861 @enumerate
10862 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
10863 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10864 @end enumerate
10865
10866 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
10867 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
10868
10869 @section Tcl Rule #1b
10870 There is a second pair of rules.
10871 @enumerate
10872 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
10873 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
10874 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
10875 in Tcl.
10876 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10877 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
10878 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
10879 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
10880 @end enumerate
10881
10882 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
10883 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
10884 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
10885 Everything is a string}
10886
10887 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
10888 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
10889 difference is subtle.
10890 @enumerate
10891 @item Parse Time
10892 @item Evaluation Time
10893 @end enumerate
10894
10895 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
10896 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
10897 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
10898
10899 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
10900 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
10901 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
10902 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
10903
10904 @itemize @bullet
10905 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
10906 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
10907 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
10908 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
10909 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
10910 @example
10911 # bash example
10912 X=`date`
10913 echo "The Date is: $X"
10914 # Tcl example
10915 set X [date]
10916 puts "The Date is: $X"
10917 @end example
10918 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
10919 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
10920 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
10921 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
10922 is a string}
10923 @example
10924 set x "Dinner"
10925 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
10926 @end example
10927 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
10928 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
10929 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
10930 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
10931 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
10932 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
10933 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
10934 @end itemize
10935
10936 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
10937
10938 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
10939
10940 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
10941
10942 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
10943 the normal way.
10944
10945 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
10946 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
10947 line is immediately executed.
10948
10949 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
10950 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
10951
10952 @subsection Command Execution
10953
10954 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
10955 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
10956 control flow operators.
10957
10958 Commands are executed like this:
10959
10960 @enumerate
10961 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
10962 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
10963 @item Repeat until End Of File.
10964 @end enumerate
10965
10966 It sort of works like this:
10967 @example
10968 for(;;)@{
10969 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
10970
10971 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
10972
10973 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
10974 @}
10975 @end example
10976
10977 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
10978 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
10979 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
10980 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
10981 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
10982 ``LookupCommand()''
10983
10984 @subsection The FOR command
10985
10986 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
10987 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
10988 command just like any other command.
10989
10990 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
10991 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
10992 are:
10993
10994 @enumerate 0
10995 @item The ascii text 'for'
10996 @item The start text
10997 @item The test expression
10998 @item The next text
10999 @item The body text
11000 @end enumerate
11001
11002 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
11003 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
11004 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
11005 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
11006
11007 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
11008 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
11009
11010 @example
11011 int
11012 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
11013 int *argc,
11014 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
11015 @end example
11016
11017 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
11018 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
11019 still operates in the same basic way.
11020
11021 @subsection FOR command implementation
11022
11023 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
11024 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
11025
11026 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
11027
11028 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
11029
11030 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
11031 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
11032 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
11033
11034 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
11035 expression and returns a value.
11036
11037 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
11038 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
11039 @example
11040 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
11041
11042 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
11043
11044 int
11045 MyForCommand( void *interp,
11046 int argc,
11047 char **argv )
11048 @{
11049 if( argc != 5 )@{
11050 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
11051 return ERROR;
11052 @}
11053
11054 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
11055
11056 // Execute the start statement.
11057 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
11058
11059 // Top of loop test
11060 for(;;)@{
11061 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
11062 if( i == 0 )
11063 break;
11064
11065 // Execute the body
11066 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
11067
11068 // Execute the LOOP part
11069 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
11070 @}
11071
11072 // Return no error
11073 SetResult( interp, "" );
11074 return SUCCESS;
11075 @}
11076 @end example
11077
11078 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
11079 in the same basic way.
11080
11081 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
11082
11083 @subsection source and find commands
11084 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
11085 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
11086 @*Remember the parsing rules
11087 @enumerate
11088 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
11089 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
11090 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
11091 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
11092 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
11093 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
11094 That character begins Tcl comments.)
11095 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
11096 it reads a file and executes as a script.
11097 @end enumerate
11098 @subsection format command
11099 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
11100 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
11101 @b{sprintf()}.
11102 @b{Example}
11103 @example
11104 set x 6
11105 set y 7
11106 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
11107 @end example
11108 @enumerate
11109 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
11110 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
11111 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
11112 @* Refer to Rule #1
11113 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
11114 @* Refer to Rule #1.
11115 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
11116 @end enumerate
11117 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
11118 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
11119 @example
11120 #1 Good
11121 proc someproc @{@} @{
11122 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
11123 @}
11124 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
11125 #2 Good - no variables
11126 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
11127 #3 Good Curly Braces
11128 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
11129 puts "Time: [date]"
11130 @}
11131 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
11132 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
11133 @end example
11134 @enumerate
11135 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
11136 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
11137 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
11138 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
11139 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
11140 command.
11141 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
11142 @*There are 4 examples:
11143 @enumerate
11144 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
11145 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
11146 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
11147 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
11148 @end enumerate
11149
11150 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
11151 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
11152 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
11153
11154 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
11155 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
11156 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
11157 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
11158 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
11159 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
11160 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
11161 @end enumerate
11162 @subsection Global Variables
11163 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
11164 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
11165 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
11166 @example
11167 proc myproc @{ @} @{
11168 set y 0 #Local variable Y
11169 global x #Global variable X
11170 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
11171 @}
11172 @end example
11173 @section Other Tcl Hacks
11174 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
11175 @example
11176 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
11177 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
11178 # Create var name
11179 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
11180 # Make it a global
11181 global $vn
11182 # Set it.
11183 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
11184 @}
11185 @end example
11186 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
11187 @example
11188 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
11189 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
11190 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
11191 @}
11192 @end example
11193
11194 @include fdl.texi
11195
11196 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
11197 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
11198 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
11199 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
11200 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
11201 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
11202
11203 @printindex cp
11204
11205 @node Command and Driver Index
11206 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
11207 @printindex fn
11208
11209 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)